Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

TB04300003E Tab29

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 80
At a glance
Powered by AI
Motor control centers provide a convenient method for grouping motor control and associated distribution equipment and can be applied on electrical systems up to 600V. They are available in NEMA 1, 2, 12 and 3R enclosures.

Motor control centers are used for grouping motor control equipment as well as associated distribution components to control motors.

Motor control centers are available in NEMA 1 Gasketed enclosures as well as NEMA 2, 12, and 3R enclosures.

Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.

0-1
January 2016
Sheet 29 001

Low Voltage
Motor Control Centers Contents
Motor Control Centers
General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Communications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
29.1-1
29.1-14
22

23
Additional Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.1-23
24
Standard Structures and Structure Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-1
Motor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-5
Metering and Bus Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-13 25
Harmonic Correction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-14
Panelboards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-14 26
Automatic Transfer Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-14
Dry-Type Transformers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-15 27
Power Factor Correction Capacitors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-15
Surge Protective Devices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-15
28
Option Groups for AC Combination Starters, AFDs. . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.2-15
Freedom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-1
General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-1 29
Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-2
SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drive Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-9 30
CPX9000 Clean Power Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-11
Freedom Arc Resistant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-1
31
General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-1
Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-2
SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drive Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-6 32
Freedom FlashGard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-1
General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-1 33
Technical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-2
SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drive Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-9 34
CPX9000 Clean Power Drives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-11

Specifications
35
See Eatons Product Specification Guide, available on CD or on the Web.
CSI Format: . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1995 2010 36
Freedom . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Section 16482A Section 26 24 19.11
FlashGard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Section 16482D Section 26 24 19.13 37

38

39

40

41

42

43
Freedom Motor Freedom Arc Resistant Freedom FlashGard
Control Center Motor Control Center Motor Control Center

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.0-2 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 002

This page intentionally left blank.


22

23

24

25

26

27

28

29

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-1
January 2016
Sheet 29 003
General Description

Freedom, Freedom Arc General Description Market Segments


22
Resistant, Freedom Eatons MCCs have been designed to
Overview meet the specific needs of several
FlashGard Motor Eatons motor control centers (MCCs) industries including: 23
Control Centers provide a convenient method for Oil and gas (upstream, downstream
grouping motor control, as well as and pipeline)
associated distribution equipment.
Water treatment and wastewater
24
MCCs may be applied on electrical
systems up to 600 V, 50 or 60 Hz, Commercial construction
having available fault currents of up Mining and aggregate 25
to 100,000 A rms. Enclosure designs Utility
include NEMA 1 Gasketed as well as
NEMA 2, 12, 3R and 3R walk-in. All Standards and Certifications 26
controllers are assembled with Eaton
UL 845 Listed
components of proven safety, quality
and reliability. All components are NEMA ICS 3 Part 1 27
wired in accordance with NEC and NEC section 430 Part H
UL standards. An ongoing tempera- Seismic compliance to IBC 2009
ture and short-circuit design test and CBC 2010 28
program, as required by UL 845, ABS certified for non-propulsion
ensures a quality product that meets loads
the latest safety codes. Freedom DC 29
CSA 22.2 No. 0.22-11 Arc Resistant
motor control centers are available
up to 250 Vdc, having available fault Tested to C37.20.7 guidelines
Freedom Motor Control Center
currents up to 22,000 A rms. A com- 30
prehensive range of communications Ratings
options are also available, including 600 Vac / 250 Vdc
DeviceNet, Modbus, PROFIBUS,
Maximum 3200 A horizontal bus
31
Modbus TCP and EtherNet/IP.
Maximum 1200 A vertical bus
MCCs provide the best method for 42 kA, 65 kA and 100 kA short 32
grouping motor control as well as asso- circuit withstand
ciated distribution equipment. Eatons
Operating temperature 0 C (32 F)
MCCs are specially designed to operate
to 40 C (104 F) 33
machinery, industrial processes and
commercial building systems. The MCC Storage temperature 40 C (40 F)
enclosure consists of a strong and rigid to 65 C (149 F) 34
self-supporting steel channel frame-
work assembled into standardized Key MCC Features
vertical sections and bolted together to Molded-case and air circuit breaker 35
form a complete shipping section of up mains
Freedom Arc Resistant to 80.00 inches (2032.0 mm) maximum,
Motor Control Center Bimetallic and solid-state overloads
four structures each. Structures include
IEEE 519 clean power drives
36
horizontal and vertical bus, insulation
and isolation barriers, horizontal and Adjustable frequency drives (AFD)
vertical isolated wiring troughs, cable up to 500 hp 37
entrance areas, and space for inserting Reduced voltage soft starts (RVSS)
starter and control equipment. All con- up to 1000 A
trol units, removable or fixed mounted, Panelboards/transformers/ATS 38
are assembled with Eaton components Metering/SPDs/feeder breakers
of proven safety, quality and reliability.
MCPs/fused switch disconnects
Specifically designed bus stabs, inser- 39
tion guides, handle mechanisms and 16- and 21-inch deep enclosures
safety interlocks are added to form a 21-inch deep back-to-back design
standardized plug-in unit that meets the 1A to 2C wiring capability 40
highest safety standards. 120 V / 240 V or 480 V coil options as
well as 24 Vdc
41
Drawout NEMA Size 1 to 5
Freedom FlashGard Motor Control Center Fixed NEMA 6 and higher
Table 29.1-1. Feature Comparison Key
42
Family 480 V and 600 V Compact Arc Smart
Lower Units Rating 43
Freedom Yes Yes Yes N/A Yes
Freedom FlashGard Yes Yes N/A Preventive Yes
Freedom Arc Resistant Yes Yes Yes Type 2 Yes

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-2 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 004
General Description

Freedom Eatons Freedom Arc Resistant motor Freedom FlashGard


22 Eatons Freedom motor control center
control center is a Type 2, 50 ms device
Eatons Freedom FlashGard motor
limited Arc offering. Device limited
has been in production since 1994 means that specific combinations of control centers are an industry first in
23 employing the Freedom NEMA
contactor in combination with multiple
devices (units and assemblies) are addressing the dangers associated
with an arc flash event by minimizing
tested so that an Arc rating can be
motor overload styles and either a achieved. The combination of devices the risk of arc flash exposure. Freedom
24 fused switch or a molded-case breaker includes all the standard Freedom FlashGard offers features to help
disconnect. The Freedom motor devices less a handful, which are prevent injury from electric shock,
control center meets all the above covered under the Features section. arc-flash burn and arc-blast impacts
25 listed standards, ratings and features. and is the first Arc Preventative MCC.
The Freedom Arc Resistant motor
Freedom Arc Resistant control center is constructed out of The Freedom FlashGard motor control
center uses a retractable stab
26 Eatons Freedom Arc Resistant is the 12-gauge sheet steel instead of the
mechanism called RotoTract that
first motor control center to be tested to standard 14-gauge including the
doors, side and back sheets and the allows the electrical worker to connect
a North American guideline specifically and disconnect line power to the unit
27 written for low voltage motor control top panels.
from behind a dead front (closed door).
centers, unlike C37.20.7 that is a The width of the MCC is 8.00 inches Visual indication of the stab position is
guideline for testing metal-enclosed (203.2 mm) wider than a standard provided on the unit door on the
28 switchgear up to 38 kV. Eatons Freedom MCC with 4.00 inches Connected and Disconnected
Freedom Arc Resistant motor control (101.6 mm) added to the left and to positions of RotoTract. Visual indication
center is tested in accordance with the right of the lineup to allow for gas on the position of the shutters that
29 CSA C22.2 No. 0.22-11 titled Evalua- to expand if an arc occurs. The depth enclose the stabs is also provided
tion methods for arc resistant ratings of of the Freedom Arc Resistant motor (open shutters indicates that stabs are
enclosed electrical equipment. To meet control center is 21.00 inches extended and closed shutters indicate
30 the CSA guideline (and also the future (533.4 mm) deep and is front mount that the stabs are withdrawn). In
C37.20.7 guideline) the following must only. The Freedom Arc Resistant motor addition, a number of safety interlocks
be met. control center is 90.00 inches prevents scenarios where removal or
31 (2286.0 mm) in height and does not insertion of FlashGard bucket could
Criterion 1: DeformationDoors,
covers and other items must not come in reduced height. The Freedom compromise arc flash safety.
32 open. Distortion and bowing of Arc Resistant does not need any
venting or plenums to vent the gas, A motorized tool, such as an electric
these items is permitted but must screwdriver with a 3/8-inch (9.5 mm)
not extend to the indicators placed allowing the MCC to be mounted
up against a wall or a ceiling to be square bit or standard 3/8-inch
33 around the enclosure for testing.
brought down to the top of the MCC. (9.5 mm) drive ratchet is required to
Criterion 2: Fragmentation operate RotoTracts retractable stab
Fragmentation of the enclosure Arc Resistant Features mechanism. An optional 120 V remote
34 must not occur. Small items/parts To meet the CSA guideline, the follow- racking accessory with a pendant
are permitted to eject as long as ing features and devices must be met. station is available as to enable the
their mass is 60 grams or less. operator to operate the RotoTract from
35 Criterion 3: Burn-throughBurn- Main breaker must be NGH or RGH safely behind the arc flash boundary
through that causes holes in the molded-case or MLO fed from NGH as prescribed by the National Fire
enclosure must not occur in the or RGH Protection Agency (NFPA).
36 freely accessible enclosure. Based Main horizontal bus up to 2500 A
on the results of this test, an RVSS to 200 hp and AFDs to 150 hp
Accessibility Type is achieved
37 (Accessibility Type 1 or Type 2).
Thermal-magnetic breaker
combination starters only
Criterion 4: IndicatorsIndicators 65 kAIC bus bracing
38 placed around the enclosure for
NEMA 1, 2 enclosures
testing must not ignite as a result
of escaping gases or particles. 21-inch front mount
39 Criterion 5: GroundingAll Insulated horizontal bus and
grounding connections must labyrinth vertical bus
remain effective. 80% rated feeder breakers up
40 to 600 A

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-3
January 2016
Sheet 29 005
General Description

NEMA Classifications (ICS 3, Part 1) Structures The free-standing structure framework


Class I Control Centers
is made of 12-gauge formed steel 22
channels. The subframes for the front
A mechanical grouping of combination and rear of each structure are welded.
motor control, feeder tap and/or other These subframes are then bolted to 23
units arranged in a convenient assem- longitudinal members to form the
bly. Connections from the common complete frame, which is rigid and self-
horizontal power bus to the units are supporting. Side, back and roof covers 24
included. Interwiring or interlocking of 14-gauge steel (except where noted)
between units or to remotely mounted are mounted with screw fasteners for
devices is not included. Only diagrams quick and easy removal. All doors are 25
of the individual units are supplied. 14-gauge steel (except where noted)
When master terminal blocks are with a 0.50-inch (12.7 mm) flange to
specified, a sketch showing general provide a rigid, secure closure for all 26
location of terminals is provided. openings. Doors mounted on remov-
able pin hinges are provided on all unit
Class II Control Centers compartments. Vertical wireways, top 27
The same as Class I, but designed horizontal wireways and bottom hori-
to form a complete control system. zontal wireways are standard.
They include the necessary electrical 28
The unit pan forms the top barrier
interlocking and interwiring between
of each unit space. In conjunction
units and interlocking provisions to
remotely mounted devices. A suitable
with the unit wrapper, this provides 29
isolation between adjacent units
diagram illustrating operation of the
and wireways. The guide rails are an
control associated with the motor
control center will be provided.
integral part of this pan and provide 30
precise alignment of the unit stabs
When master terminal blocks are on the vertical bus.
specified, the terminal arrangement
Standard Structure Arrangements
31
and required wiring connections are
shown on the diagram. Standard structural height is
Standard StructureSide View 90.00 inches (2286.0 mm) with 32
NEMA Types of Wiring 9.00-inch (228.6 mm) horizontal wire-
Type A includes no unit terminal Construction ways available at top and bottom for
blocks and no unit-to-unit wiring. The standard vertical structure is wiring. The balance of vertical com- 33
Combination line starters power 90.00 inches (2286.0 mm) high and partments, 72.00 inches (1828.8 mm),
wiring are factory wired and assembled 20.00 inches (508.0 mm) wide. Front- is available for mounting of control
in the structure in the most efficient mounted-only structures can be units. This space can provide up to 12 34
arrangement. Auxiliary devices can either 16.00 inches (406.4 mm) or 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) high (X spaces)
be supplied, wired or unwired as 21.00 inches (533.4 mm) deep. Front- or any combination thereof.
specified. All feeder circuit breaker to-back unit mounting is 21.00 inches
Note: In the rear of common vertical bus
35
or fusible disconnect units are in (533.4 mm) deep. Bolted back-to-back
front-to-back structures, the top horizontal
this classification. can be in 16.00-inch (406.4 mm) wireway is 15.00 inches (381.0 mm) high
Type B duplicates Type A except that
or 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep and the bottom wireway is 9.00 inches 36
structures. (228.6 mm). This means that front-to-back
all control wires terminate at terminal structures have only 66.00 inches
blocks on the side or near the bottom (1676.4 mm) 11X of usable space in 37
of each unit. Removable terminal the rear. 72.00-inch (1828.8 mm) 12X of
blocks are standard for all control mounting space is available with a 3.00-inch
wiring. (76.2 mm) bottom wireway. Two front-
mounted only structures can be supplied
38
Type C-S all factory-supplied control in a front-to-back configuration, allowing
terminals are brought to a master 12X rear usable space (depth dimension
terminal block located in the structure. will increase). 39
Type C-M all factory-supplied control
terminals are brought to a master 40
terminal block located in a separate
marshaling structure.
41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-4 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 006
General Description

Special Structures Indoor enclosures comply with NEC Horizontal Wireways


22 In addition to the standard 20.00-inch UL 845s Two Meter Rule when the
(508.0 mm) wide structure, extra wide bottom of the MCC is at the same
structures are available in 4.00-inch level as the operators platform. MCCs
23 (101.6 mm) increments up to elevated on a raised pad or installed
40.00 inches (1016.0) wide. on unembedded channel sills may
require operator handle extensions
24 Reduced height structures, in increments for the uppermost operators. Handle
of 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) 1X from 90.00 extensions are optionally available and
to 54.00 inches (2286.0 to 1371.6 mm), may be installed on-site.
25 are available for applications with
limited access. Seismic Qualification
Top Horizontal Wireway
26 Another special structure is a transition
section between Type W and the
Freedom Series. This structure
27 is 10.00 inches (254.0 mm) wide to
provide for horizontal bus splicing.
Paint Refer to Tab 1 for information on
28 All enclosure parts are thoroughly seismic qualification for this and Bottom Horizontal Wireway
cleaned and given a phosphatizing other Eaton products.
treatment to inhibit rust and to prime The top front horizontal wireway is
29 the metal for the finish coating. A 2 mil Vertical Wireway 9.00 inches (228.6 mm) high and
thick electrostatic powder paint coat 8.00 inches (203.2 mm) deep in front-
A vertical wireway is provided in each mounted only structures and in the
30 is applied to all surfaces. The paint
type and process meets UL 1332 for
structure. Located on the right side, it front of back-to-back mounted struc-
extends the full 90.00-inch (2286.0 mm) tures. It extends the full width of each
electrical equipment steel enclosures. height of the structure. The width of the structure and is totally isolated from
31 All exterior enclosure covers and wireway is 4-5/8 inches (117.5 mm) at the main horizontal bus. The bottom
doors are painted ANSI 61 gray the rear of the vertical frame members.
(Munsell No. 8.3G/6.10/0.54). For horizontal wireway is 9.00 inches
Overall depth of the wireway is 8.00 (228.6 mm) high and extends the full
32 improved interior visibility, the inches (203.2 mm) providing a cross- depth of the structure. The entire floor
interior of the enclosure and sectional area of nearly 35 square
plug-in units are painted white area under the control center is open
inches (889 square mm) to easily for unrestricted conduit entry. For top
33 (Munsell No. N9.43/0.21B, 0.23). accommodate control and load entry, the top wireway can be increased
wiring. Supports are provided at
Enclosures to 15.00 inches (381.0 mm) high,
suitable intervals to secure all reducing the bottom wireway height
34 The standard enclosure type is wiring and cables. to 3.00 inches (76.2 mm).
NEMA Type 1 Gasketed General
PurposeIndoor. This enclosure The doors swing open 115 and For back-to-back unit mounted,
35 is appropriate for installations with opposite to the unit doors for maxi-
mum accessibility. The doors are
the rear top horizontal wireway is
normal atmospheric conditions. 15.00 inches (381.0 mm) high and
mounted on concealed removable 5.00 inches (127.0 mm) deep.
The NEMA Type 2 DripproofIndoor
36 employs a special roof panel with a
pin hinges for quick detachment and
are secured in the closed position by All horizontal wireway openings
drip shield and water channels. This spring-loaded quarter-turn indicating are covered by doors for increased
prevents liquid from dripping onto
37 the front of the control center.
type fastener. accessibility. Each door is mounted
with removable pin hinges to allow
The NEMA Type 3R Rainproof and quick detachment.
38 Sleet ResistantOutdoor consists
of a NEMA 1 gasketed enclosure Bus System
mounted on a special base with an The bus system is designed to
39 outdoor house erected around and efficiently distribute power
over it. Non-walk-in, walk-in aisle throughout the MCC and provides
and tunnel types are available. inherent mechanical strength in
40 the event of faults.
The NEMA Type 12 Dust-tight and
DriptightIndoor has gasketed
41 material around all doors, door
cutouts, cover plates, side, top and
back sheets. A gasketed bottom plate
42 is provided with this enclosure. This
construction provides maximum
protection against airborne matter
43 and dripping liquids.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-5
January 2016
Sheet 29 007
General Description

Vertical Bus its mechanical strength is better able to An automatic shutter mechanism
withstand the stresses of unit insertion is standard with the labyrinth barrier 22
and removal on and off the bus. Vertical to provide complete isolation of the
bus of the incoming section will match vertical bus. The shutter moves
the horizontal bus when applicable. automatically to cover the stab 23
openings when a unit is removed.
Isolation of the Freedom vertical bus This provides maintenance personnel
compartment from the unit compart- with maximum protection because the 24
ment is accomplished by a full height vertical bus is never exposed. As the
isolation barrier, which is a single unit is reinserted in the compartment,
Vertical Bus Configuration
sheet of glass-reinforced polyester the shutter moves sideways to uncover 25
with cutouts to allow the unit stabs the stab openings in the barrier.
The vertical bus provides three-phase to engage the vertical bus. Snap-in
power distribution from the main covers are available for the cutout 26
horizontal bus into the vertical openings to provide total isolation
compartments. The bus is a unique during maintenance procedures.
angular configuration with a Z 27
shape for front-mounted structures
and for back-to-back. These shapes
have the inherent mechanical strength 28
to withstand fault stresses. They also
provide a smooth stabbing surface for
unit connection. 29

30

Labyrinth Barrier with


31
Standard Isolation Barrier Automatic Shutter Mechanism

Horizontal Bus 32

33

34

35

36
Horizontal Bus

The main horizontal bus provides 37


three-phase power distribution
from the incoming line or primary
MCC Bus Layout Standard Isolation Barrier Rear View disconnect device to each vertical 38
Due to the high-strength capability structure in the motor control center.
When insulation and isolation of the
of the bus bars, bus bracing at The bus bars are mounted in a vertical
vertical bus is required, a labyrinth
65,000 rms symmetrical amperes is design barrier, as shown below, as
plane, edge to edge. This mounting 39
standard. Optional bracing is available produces an exceptionally strong
an option for Freedom and as a
at 42,000 and 100,000 A rms. Bus assembly, able to withstand high
standard for Freedom Arc Resistant 40
braces are molded from a glass- fault current stresses.
and Freedom FlashGard. This barrier is
reinforced polyester material, which molded glass-reinforced polyester and The main horizontal bus is rated at
is non-tracking and impervious forms a labyrinth around the bus bars
to moisture and other adverse to prevent fault propagation. This
600 A as standard with ratings of 800, 41
1200, 1600, 2000, 2500 and 3200 A
atmospheric operating conditions. design provides maximum protection optionally available. Tin-plated copper
The vertical bus is available in against phase-to-phase insulation horizontal bus bars are supplied as 42
ratings of 600, 800 and 1200 A for breakdown. Thermal efficiency is standard. Silver-plated copper
front-mounted only, and 600, 800 maintained by a close tolerance fit horizontal bus bars are an option.
and 1200 A for back-to-back mounted. between the bus bars and the barrier, 43
which minimizes air pockets. Note: 3200 A horizontal bus available in
Vertical bus bars are tin-plated copper NEMA 1A enclosure only and 65 C rise
only. In addition to tin plating having above 40 C ambient only.
environmental superiority over silver,

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-6 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 008
General Description

The horizontal main bus is isolated Units Typical starter units available include
22 from the top horizontal wireway the following:
compartment by a metal isolation General
Full voltage, non-reversing
barrier. This two-piece steel barrier Motor starter units are combination
23 extends to the full width of each vertical type employing a linestarter and a Full voltage, reversing
structure. The two-piece design allows disconnect device of proven capability. Two-speed, single winding
access to bus connections without the The disconnect device can be a High and two winding
24 removal of the entire barrier, for added interrupting Motor Circuit Protector Reduced voltage, autotransformer,
maintenance convenience. The bus (HMCP), Thermal-Magnetic (TM) closed transition
bar layout permits front access to breaker or fusible switch. Eatons Reduced voltage, wye delta
25 all bus connections. This allows Type HMCP and HMCPE motor circuit
maintenance personnel to make Reduced voltage, part winding
protectors are furnished as standard.
splices and check splice bolt torques Reduced voltage, solid-state (RVSS)
26 from the front of the structure. All starters and soft starters through Adjustable frequency drives (AFD)
NEMA Size 5 are a drawout design
Neutral Assemblies except Size 5 electromechanical Each starter includes a stainless steel
27 reduced voltage. Size 5 optionally corrosion-resistant safety ground clip
can be bolt-in if requested. that makes connection before the
power stabs engage the vertical bus.
28 All feeder breakers through 400 A
are a drawout design. UnitsFreedom and Freedom
All dimensions and ratings in the Arc Resistant
29 following tables are based on NEMA
Design B, 1800 RPM motors.
30 The HMCP/HMCPE and starter
Neutral Bus (Bottom) combination has a 65,000 rms
symmetrical ampere short-circuit
31 For three-phase, four-wire applications, current rating as standard at 480 V.
a neutral landing pad is provided as Starter units are available with
standard. This is a 100% rated neutral. optional 100,000 A short-circuit
32 As an option, half or fully rated neutral current rating. Series C thermal-
bus can be supplied in the bottom of magnetic circuit breakers (65 kAIC,
the entire MCC. or optional 100 kAIC) for starter
33 units are also available.
Ground Bus
Freedom, Freedom Arc Resistant and Freedom FVNR Starter
34 Freedom FlashGard starters meet or
Freedom and Freedom Arc Resistant
exceed IEC 947-4 Type II testing with
HMCP, or R and J fuses (Freedom Arc starter units are equipped with Eatons
35 Resistant is HMCP only). Freedom starters and contactors
NEMA Sizes 1 through 5. Size 6
The fusible switch disconnect device and 7 starters are A200 type. These
is the Type K. It is a quick-make, quick-
36 break, visible blade switch with fuse
contactors have been successfully
applied in thousands of the most
clips for use with current-limiting or demanding industrial applications.
dual element, rejection type, NEMA
37 Ground Bus (Top)
Class J or R fuses. Rejection fuse clips
Overload protection is provided
by a three-pole adjustable ambient
Copper ground bus, rated 300 A for Class RK-5 fuses are standard. compensated, bi-metallic thermal
0.25-inch by 1.00-inch (6.4 mm by Fuses are not included as standard.
38 25.4 mm) is supplied as standard.
overload relay. The overload relay also
Both breaker and fuse selection provides single-phase sensitivity and
Mounting is across the top of each
must take into consideration the isolated alarm contact. As an option,
vertical structure in the horizontal
39 wireway. The bus can also be mounted total short-circuit capacity of the the overload relay can be upgraded to
system to which the control center a standard solid-state overload or an
across the bottom when the bottom
is connected. For a fused switch and advanced solid-state overload as
9.00 inches (228.6 mm) are not
40 occupied by units or master terminal starter combination, a 100 kA SCCR described on Page 29.1-21. An
at 600 V can be achieved. insulated hand reset button extends
blocks. A 0.25-inch by 2.00-inch
through the compartment door.
(6.4 mm by 50.8 mm) optional copper
41 ground bus rated 600 or 800 A is
Additionally, motor running data and
starter status/control are available
also available.
through one of the many industrial
42 An optional 300 A vertical tin-plated standard communication protocols.
only copper ground bus is available. Freedom Arc Resistant adds line and
Located in the vertical wireway, it load shields to the disconnect.
43 provides direct starter unit grounding.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-7
January 2016
Sheet 29 009
General Description

UnitsFreedom FlashGard Starter Controllers are available to handle


constant torque applications, such as 22
Racking Tool Receiver Unit Latch conveyors and crushers, and variable
torque applications, such as fans and
Power Stab pumps. Control schemes are available 23
Position Internal Shutter for volts/Hz, open loop vector and
Connected Position closed loop vector models. SVX9000
Disconnected Open drive units include as standard: line 24
Closed reactors and a door-mounted keypad.
Handle Units up to 150 hp VT come standard
Mechanism with a 3% output reactor. MMX drive 25
units do not contain line or load
reactors and can be added as an option.
Breaker All drive structures are bus connected, 26
which allows for expansion of the MCC
on both sides of the structure. A wide
Pilot Device
Island
range of AFD features and options are 27
Starter available to meet the requirements of
Start, Stop,
Auto/Man
most applications including IEEE 519
compliant applications. AFDs are 28
available in NEMA 1A gasketed
enclosures. AFDs are available in
Freedom FlashGard FVNR Starter
NEMA 3R MCC enclosures from 29
1200 hp, constant torque.
The Freedom FlashGard units are Freedom FlashGard starters are
equipped with a retractable stab equipped with electromechanical UnitsSolid-State 30
mechanism called RotoTract, that starters and contactors NEMA Reduced Voltage Starters (SSRV)
allows the electrical worker to connect size 15.
and disconnect power to the bucket 31
with the unit door closed, thereby UnitsAdjustable
minimizing exposure to arc flash. A Frequency Drives
visual indication is provided on the 32
unit door on the Connected and
Disconnected positions of RotoTract.
A visual indication on the position of 33
the shutters that enclose the stabs is
also provided (open shutters indicate
that stabs are extended and closed
34
shutters indicate that the stabs are
withdrawn). A motorized tool such
as an electric screwdriver, drill with
35
a 3/8-inch square drill bit or standard S811+ SSRV
3/8-inch drive ratchet is used to operate
RotoTract through its racking tool
S811+ Solid-State Reduced Voltage 36
(SSRV) starters are designed to reduce
receiver. the inrush current to a motor during
Additional safety features of a starting and to limit the amount 37
FlashGard unit include: of available starting torque, thus
reducing mechanical wear and utility
Unit LatchWhen the RotoTract is in demand requirements. The amount 38
Connected position, this latch is of starting current is field adjustable
mechanically interlocked to hook the to match the specific requirements of
bucket to the divider pan that sepa- all applications. 39
rates the bucket from the unit above,
thereby preventing physical removal Eatons S811+ SSRV controllers are
available with a wide variety of
of the bucket when it is connected to
standard features: kick start, soft stop,
40
480 V and/or control power. The unit
latch also prevents insertion of a phase loss and stall protection. S811+
SSRV starters are 3070% smaller than
bucket with the stabs extended
competitive designs and contain an
41
RotoTract racking tool receiver Adjustable Frequency Drive integral fully rated bypass relay that
shutterWhen the breaker is in the almost eliminates heat generation
On position, the shutter for the Adjustable Frequency Drives are
when the motor is at speed.
42
access hole in the RotoTract (access available from 0.51100 hp for
hole is needed for the motorized control of standard AC motors in Typical applications include
tool to retract the stabs) is closed, processes that benefit from the ability conveyors, compressors, machine 43
thereby not allowing the stabs to to change motor speed. Use of Inverter tools, pumps and fans.
be retracted when the breaker Duty motors is recommended.
is energized

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-8 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 010
General Description

UnitsDC Starters All switches are supplied with fuse This ensures a positive connection
22 clips for use with current-limiting or yet permits easy unit insertion and
dual-element rejection type. Types of withdrawal. Self-aligning stabs are
fuses include Class J, R or L, which are mounted in a glass-reinforced plastic
23 supplied by others. insulation block that totally shrouds
each stab and absolutely ensures
Freedom FlashGard Feeder positive alignment of the stabs with
24 Tap Units the vertical bus. The insulation block is
also an integral part of the phase-to-
phase isolation system. Power wiring
25 is welded to the stabs and is totally
contained within the unit enclosure.
This means the vertical bus compart-
26 ment is completely free of wiring for
maximum safety and reliability.

27 Stab assemblies are accurately matched


DC Starter Unit to the electrical requirements of each
individual unit and are provided in
UL listed DC MCCs use combination
28 circuit breaker DC starters suitable for
60, 150, 300 or 400 A ratings (plug-in
through Size 5).
motor starting duty only. Using Eatons
Type ME DC definite purpose contac- Circuit Breaker Handle Mechanism
29 tors, all DC starters are suitable for up
Freedom FlashGard Stab Assembly
to 250 Vdc and have a 22 kA withstand Feeder tap units may contain either
circuit breakers or fusible switches. Stabs Extended
rating. Class 135 starting resistors for
30 reduced voltage starters are sized Drawout breaker units include the
for 200% starting current. Typical fixed trip Type HFD, single-mounted
applications include emergency lube in ratings through 150 A and the
31 oil pumps, emergency seal oil pumps interchangeable trip Type HJD single-
and emergency turning gear motors. mounted through 250 A and Type HKD
single-mounted through 400 A. Larger
32 Freedom and Freedom Arc Series C circuit breakers with ratings
to 2500 A are fixed-mounted.
Resistant Feeder Tap Units
33 Fusible feeder tap units use Eatons
Stabs Withdrawn
Type K visible blade disconnect switch.
Fused switches are mounted in drawout
34 units through 400 A with 30 A and 60 A
ratings available in dual mountings.
Fixed-mounted switch ratings of 600 A
35 and 800 A are also available.
All switches are supplied with fuse
clips for use with current-limiting or
36 dual-element rejection type. Types of
fuses include Class J, R or L supplied Freedom FlashGard Plug-in Unit Bus Stabs

37 Freedom Dual Feeder Tap Unit by others. The Freedom FlashGard MCC uses a
Feeder tap units may contain either retractable stab mechanism, called
Freedom and Freedom Arc RotoTract, that allows the electrician to
circuit breakers or fusible switches;
38 Freedom Arc Resistant only contains Resistant Stab Assembly connect and disconnect power to the
circuit breakers. Freedom drawout bucket with the unit door closed.
breaker units include the fixed trip A visual indication is provided on
39 Type HFD, single-or dual-mounted the unit door on the Connected
in ratings through 150A and the and Disconnected positions of
interchangeable trip Types HJD and RotoTract. A visual indication on the
40 HKD single-mounted through 250 A position of the shutters that enclose
and 400 A respectively. Larger Series C the stabs is also provided (open
circuit breakers with ratings to 2500 A shutters indicate that stabs are
41 are fixed-mounted. extended and closed shutters indicate
that the stabs are withdrawn). A
Fusible feeder tap units use Eatons motorized tool or standard 3/8-inch
42 Type K visible blade disconnect switch. (9.5 mm) drive ratchet is used to
Fused switches are mounted in drawout operate RotoTracts retractable stab
units through 400 A with 30 A and 60 A Freedom Plug-in Unit Bus Stabs mechanism. A wired remote racking
43 ratings available in dual mountings.
A tin-plated copper alloy stab incor- accessory is also available for operat-
Fixed-mounted switch ratings of 600 A ing RotoTract with a pendant station
porates the ultimate in mechanical
and 800 A are also available. safely beyond the NFPA-prescribed
simplicity to provide precise control
of contact pressure on the bus. flash protection boundaries.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-9
January 2016
Sheet 29 011
General Description

The stabs are constructed from a tin- To ensure that units are not energized
plated copper alloy, incorporating the accidentally or by unauthorized 22
ultimate in mechanical simplicity to personnel, the handle mechanism
provide precise control of contact can be padlocked in the OFF position.
pressure on the bus. This ensures Sufficient space is available for a 23
a positive connection, yet permits maximum of three padlocks. Where
easy unit insertion and withdrawal. critical processes are involved and
The stabs are self-aligning and are to prevent unauthorized shutdown, 24
mounted in a glass-reinforced plastic the handle mechanism can be
insulation block, which totally shrouds modified to enable padlocking in t
each stab and ensures positive he ON position 25
alignment of the stabs with the vertical
bus. The insulation block is also an Freedom FlashGard Handle
integral part of the phasephase Unit Insertion Interlock Mechanism 26
isolation system. Power wiring is
welded to the stabs and is totally The handle and exterior front panel are
contained within the unit enclosure. molded from the same plastic material 27
The wire is designed for a high level of as the device panel. A textured surface
flexibility to be suitable for RotoTracts preserves the appearance. The ON
retractable stab mechanism. position indicator is at the top and is 28
a bright red. The OFF/RESET position
Stab assemblies are accurately is at the bottom and is bright green.
matched to the electrical requirements The TRIP position, a bright yellow, is 29
of each individual unit and are in the middle, between the ON and OFF
provided in 60 A, 150 A, 300 A or 400 A position. All position indicator colors
ratings (plug-in through Size 5). contrast with the black background and 30
are highly visible even at considerable Circuit Breaker Handle Mechanism
Freedom and Freedom Arc distances. The operating handle is
Resistant Handle Mechanism designed for rugged duty and solid The handle mechanism is designed to 31
operator feel. provide a high mechanical leverage, so
that little effort is required to operate
any device. 32
The standard handle mechanism is a
vertical motion type device with four 33
positions: ON, OFF, TRIPPED and RESET.
Only circuit breaker types have tripped
and reset positions. It is securely 34
mounted to the front of the unit and
mechanically connected to the breaker
or fusible switch, eliminating align-
ment problems. It provides a positive
35
indication of the breaker or switch
Padlocking Bar
position, even with the door open. 36
Circuit Breaker Handle Mechanism The handle mechanism provides
The handle mechanism is designed to several safety features: 37
provide a high mechanical leverage so In the ON position, an interlock
that little effort is required to operate
any device.
prevents the unit door from being 38
opened. A door interlock defeater
The standard handle mechanism is a screw located above the handle
vertical motion type device with four is provided to enable authorized 39
positions: ON, OFF, TRIPPED and RESET. maintenance personnel access to
Only circuit breaker types have tripped the units when required
and reset positions. It is securely With the unit door open and the 40
mounted to the front of the unit and operating handle in the ON position,
mechanically connected to the breaker an interlock slides into a slot in the
or fusible switch, eliminating alignment divider pan above and prevents 41
problems. It provides a positive indica- removal of the unit. This same Unit Insertion Interlock
tion of the breaker or switch position, interlock prevents insertion of the
even with the door open. unit unless the handle mechanism The handle and exterior front panel are 42
is in the OFF position. The interlock molded from the same plastic material
also prevents the operating handle as the device panel. A textured surface
from being turned on with the unit preserves the appearance. The ON 43
door open position indicator is at the top and is
a bright red. The OFF/RESET position
is at the bottom and is bright green.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-10 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 012
General Description

The TRIP position, a bright yellow, is Device Panel The unit wrapper is designed to
22 in the middle, between the ON and provide ample space for cable entry
OFF position. All position indicator from the wireway to the unit.
colors contrast with the black back-
23 ground and are highly visible even at The unit wrapper has four mounting
considerable distances. The operating points, two on each side, which support
handle is designed for rugged duty the unit in the structure. They engage
24 and solid operator feel. guide rails located near the top of each
unit space. This mounting point guide
rail system produces minimum friction
25 and allows units to be inserted and
withdrawn easily. The guide rails also
give precise alignment to the unit for
26 Standard Device Panel accurate stabbing on the vertical bus.

The device panel can accommodate


Padlocking Bar
27 up to six 1-3/16-inch (30.2 mm) Eatons
The handle mechanism for Freedom 10250T type pilot devices such as
FlashGard provides several safety oiltight pushbuttons, indicating lights,
28 features: selector switches and miniature meters.

In the ON position, an interlock Molded into the panel is a knockout for


each device location. This facilitates the
29 prevents the unit door from being
future addition of devices to the panel.
opened. A door interlock defeater
screw located to the right of the The device panel is hinged on a
30 handle is provided to enable horizontal pivot tube extending across
authorized maintenance personnel the front of the unit. With the unit door
access to the units when required open, loosening two captive retaining
31 The unit insertion interlock is located screws at the top of the panel and
Freedom FlashGard Plug-in Unit Wrapper
to the left of the operating handle. sliding it 0.50-inch (12.7 mm) left,
The interlock must be in the locked permits it to swing down. This
32 position in order to turn the discon- provides ready access to the rear of Freedom and Freedom Arc
nect on. When the interlock is in the the panel and increased accessibility Resistant Unit Wrapper
locked position, the unit cannot be to the unit interior. The FlashGard unit wrapper is
33 withdrawn or inserted equipped with a quarter-turn side
To ensure that units are not
Nameplates
wrapper latch that securely holds the
energized accidentally or by Unit nameplates are 1.00 x 2.50 inches unit in the compartment. The latch can
34 unauthorized personnel, the handle (25.4 x 63.5 mm) and engraved with only be engaged when the stabs are
mechanism can be padlocked in 3/16-inch (4.8 mm) high white lettering fully mated with the vertical bus. Upon
the OFF position. Sufficient space on a black background (black lettering release of the latch, the unit can be
35 is available for a maximum of three on a white background optional). partially withdrawn such that the stabs
padlocks. Where critical processes They are heat- and crack-resistant to disengage from the vertical bus. In this
are involved and to prevent eliminate the need for replacement. position, the latch can be re-engaged
36 unauthorized shutdown, the Nameplates are mounted with to prevent the unit from being
handle mechanism can be stainless steel self-tapping screws. returned to the fully stabbed position
modified to enable padlocking or from being removed from the
37 in the ON position Freedom FlashGard Unit Wrapper structure. The latch can be padlocked
The unit wrapper is fabricated of in this position to ensure that the
Each unit has a safe lock position. This 14-gauge steel. After fabrication, it stabs remain disengaged during
38 interlock will lock the unit in a position is cleaned and given a rust inhibiting maintenance.
off the 480 V bus and ensure the unit phosphatizing treatment. The finish on
cannot be inserted or withdrawn. a unit wrapper is a baked Munsell No.
39 N9.43/0.21B, 0.23 white. This is highly
durable finish, gloss-white in color to
increase visibility within the unit and
40 to facilitate wiring and maintenance
Unit
Side procedures.
Latch
41 Screw The unit wrapper consists of a three-
sided rugged steel shell including
the mounting base for the unit
42 components. The smallest unit
measures 13-3/4 inches (349.3 mm)
Freedom FlashGard Unit wide, 8.00 inches (203.2 mm) deep
43 Wrapper Side Latch and 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) high.
Units increase in 6.00-inch (152.4 mm)
increments to a maximum height of
72.00 inches (1828.8 mm). Freedom Plug-in Unit Wrapper

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-11
January 2016
Sheet 29 013
General Description

Unit Maintenance Heavy-duty saddle wire terminals are Doors 2X and larger are held closed
of the resilient collar design, which with a minimum of two quarter-turn 22
eliminates loose connections caused indicating-type fasteners. They securely
by expansion and contracting of the hold the door in the closed position,
conductor as the current is switched yet allow quick and easy access to 23
on and off. This unique design main- the unit when required. The fasteners
tains constant pressure as the wire provide a visual indication of the
expands and contracts. This 600 V, 30 A latched position. The head slot of 24
rated terminal block will accept 12 AWG the fastener is designed to prevent
stripped wires, as well as 14 AWG ring screwdriver slippage.
or spade wire lugs. All terminal block 25
conductors are fully shielded for
added safety and cleanliness.
26
A 12.00-inch (304.8 mm) high
(2X space) starter unit accommodates
up to three side-mounted terminal 27
blocks providing a maximum of 21
points. Larger units accommodate
two additional 7-point terminal blocks 28
for every additional 6.00 inches
(152.4 mm) 1X space of unit height.
Plug-in Unit Maintenance The 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) compact 29
starter unit uses a 9-point pull-apart
The Freedom three-piece (clam shell) terminal block, which is installed along
unit wrapper design facilitates easy the top front of the starter unit. 30
work bench maintenance. When
removed from the MCC, the unit Control wiring within each starter
top/side barrier assembly can easily compartment consists of 16 AWG 31
be swiveled up and back for complete control wire for Freedom FlashGard Freedom 12.00-Inch (304.8 mm)
access to components and wiring. MCCs and 2100 Series MCCs. Rated Unit Door
105 C, the flame-retardant, thermo- 32
Terminal Blocks plastic insulated wire is red. Power
wiring is black and sized to carry the
A side-mounted, seven-circuit,
maximum full load current of the 33
latching pull-apart terminal block is
starter unit.
standard on units with NEMA Type B
or C wiring. This industrial-grade Front-Rail-Mounted Terminal Blocks
Eaton MCC terminal block provides For special applications, other types of
34
solid electrical connections while rail-mounted terminal blocks are also
conserving space and making available. They are installed horizon-
installation and maintenance easier. tally at the bottom front of the starter
35
Terminal blocks are mounted in knock- unit. Refer to Eaton for terminal block
outs on the vertical wireway side of the types available and space restrictions. 36
unit housing affording greater access
to the unit compartment and interior Unit Doors Freedom FlashGard 12.00-Inch (304.8 mm)
Unit Door
components. The two-piece terminal Unit doors are formed of 14-gauge steel 37
block snap-locks together to ensure with a 0.50-inch (12.7 mm) flange on all
permanent circuit continuity. To aid four sides. The flange adds rigidity to
installation and wiring checks, the the door and provides a surface to 38
terminal marking strips for both contain door gasketing. Cutouts are
sides of the terminal block are fully made in the door as required to
visible from the front of the starter accommodate the operating handle 39
compartment. and device panel. The doors are
cleaned, phosphatized and given a
finish of gray, baked-on enamel ANSI 61 40
(Munsell No. N9.43/0.21B, 0.23).
The doors will open 115 opposite
to the wireway doors permitting
41
optimum access to the unit compart-
ment. The doors are mounted on 42
removable concealed pin hinges. This
permits quick removal of any door in
a vertical structure without disturbing Spring-Loaded Unit Door Quarter-Turn Latch 43
adjacent doors.

Side MountedLatched
Pull-Apart Terminal Block

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-12 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 014
General Description

Options Control and Load Terminations Incoming Line


22 Eatons starter and feeder tap units Incoming line cables entering the
can be modified to meet a variety of MCC from either the top or bottom can
specification requirements. Some be easily terminated onto main lugs
23 typical components that can be added or connected to a main disconnect.
include: control power transformers All incoming line sections comply
with two primary and one secondary with NEC wiring bending requirements
24 control fuses, control relays, solid-state as adopted by UL.
overload relays, ground fault relays,
current transformers, extra electrical Main Lugs Only (MLO)
25 interlocks, pushbuttons, selector Up to 1200A rated horizontal bus,
switches, indicating lights, circuit cables, up to four per phase, are
breaker shunt trip or undervoltage terminated on crimp or screw lugs
26 release and auxiliary switches. In
Master Terminal Blocks at Bottom
(Class C Wiring) mounted on adapters solidly bolted
most cases, one of these modifications to fully rated vertical bus. Top entry
does not increase starter unit size. For NEMA Type A wiring, each unit cables are terminated at the top of
27 is assembled and devices interwired. the MCC and bottom entry cables
Additional Equipment Terminal blocks are not supplied and are conveniently terminated near the
control and load wiring is internal to bottom. Table 29.2-4 shows spacing
28 In addition to motor starter and feeder the unit. requirements for various cable
units, additional equipment can be
configurations. MLO termination
supplied including the following: For NEMA Type B wiring, control wires
for 1600, 2000, 2500 and 3200 A
29 Single-phase dry-type distribution
are terminated at blocks within the
requires a full vertical section.
unit. Refer to the discussion of units
transformers in ratings of 0.5, 0.75, for types of terminal blocks available. Note: 3200 A main lugs only available in
30 1, 1.5, 2, 3, 5, 7.5, 10, 15, 20, 25, 30 NEMA 1 enclosure only and 65 C rise
and 45 kVA For NEMA Type C-S wiring, control above 40 C ambient only.
Three-phase dry-type distribution and load wires are extended from the
unit terminal blocks to master terminal
31 transformers in ratings of 9, 15, 25,
blocks located at the top or bottom of
Main Disconnects
30 and 45 kVA Incoming cables may also be easily
each vertical structure. terminated on a main circuit breaker or
Lighting panelboards with up to
32 42 circuits with either plug-in branch The mounting location of the master fused switch. A variety of main circuit
breakers or bolt-on branch breakers, terminal block in front-mounted only breakers are available. Tables 29.3-17
120/240 V, 120/208 V or 480 V, single- structures is in the existing horizontal through 29.3-22 show spacing require-
33 or three-phase wireway space at the top or at the ments for various main devices.
Metering equipment including the bottom as shown above. When
IQ family of solid-state power mounting is made in an incoming Metering
34 monitors, voltmeters and ammeters line section, 12.00 inches (304.8 mm)
PLC and DCS I/O racks of unit space must be used. When
mounting is made in the rear of
35 S811+ family of solid-state reduced
back-to-back mounted structures,
voltage starters
6.00 inches (152.4 mm) of unit space
SVX9000 and MMX adjustable- must be used at the bottom and
36 frequency controllers 12.00 inches (304.8 mm) used at
Active harmonic correction units the top.
Surge protective device (SPD) units
37 Size 4, 5 and 6 vacuum starters
Master terminal blocks are rack-
mounted to permit removal of entire
and contactors assembly for ease of wiring during
38 Power factor correction capacitors installation and maintenance. IQ 250/260 Electronic Power Meter
Automatic transfer switches
For NEMA Type C-M wiring, control IQ 100 series meters are microprocessor-
DeviceNet, Modbus, PROFIBUS, and load wires are extended from based three-phase power monitors
39 Modbus TCP, EtherNet/IP the unit terminal blocks to master that replace the traditional ammeter,
Communications terminal blocks located in a separate voltmeter and instrument switches.
Power Xpert communications The meters display phase currents,
40 marshaling structure.
voltage, L-L, L-N, power-real and reactive
Industrial Operator Interface
Industrial PLCs and PCs apparent, power factor, frequency,
41 energy (watthours, VAR-hours and
VA-hours) at 0.5% accuracy. Options
include Modbus RTU, Modbus TCP
42 and KYZ outputs.

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-13
January 2016
Sheet 29 015
General Description

IQ 200 series meters are microprocessor- FlashGard Remote Racking Automatic Insulation Tester
based three-phase power monitors
Accessory (Motorguard)
22
that replace the traditional ammeter,
voltmeter and instrument switches.
The meters display phase currents, 23
voltage, L-L, L-N, power-real and reactive
apparent, power factor, frequency,
energy (watthours, VAR-hours and 24
VA-hours) at 0.1% accuracy. Advanced
versions also display THD readings for
voltage and current as well as discrete 25
inputs and outputs that are ideal for
incoming line metering.
26
Power Xpert 2000 series meters
include all the features of the
IQ 200 series meters with an added 27
communication port supporting
Web services, Ethernet industrial
Remote Racking Accessory
communications including Modbus 28
TCP and BACnet/IP as well as DNP 3.0. Performs RotoTract racking safely
All Power Xpert meters support field behind NFPA Arc Flash boundaries Automatic Insulation Tester (Motorguard)
upgradable firmware. 120 Vac motor driven Meggers equipment motor 29
IQ Analyzer provides extensive meter- Mounts to RotoTract mechanism insulation to continuously monitor
ing, power quality analysis, remote Wired pendant station for integrity of insulation for the period
input monitoring, control relaying, rack-in/rack-out operation that the equipment is de-energized 30
analog input/outputs and is communi- Momentary jog Applies 500 Vdc potential at current-
cations capable. A display provides the limited, operator-safe maximum
flexibility of exhibiting large characters
Mounting offset bracket to clear
amperage of 200 microamperes
31
device panel
with high visibility and small characters Alarms upon detection of a
for detailed descriptions. These IQ threshold leakage to ground current 32
power monitors each contain their own
Voltage Presence Indicator
Visual alarm indication and lockout;
voltage power pack for systems up to (VoltageVision) Form C contact available for remote
600 V. Therefore, separate potential alarm status 33
transformers are not required. Either
two or three separate current trans- FlashGard Padlock Accessory
formers must be used. All IQ power 34
monitors are communications capable.
Refer to Tab 3 for further details.
Power Xpert 4000/6000/8000 meters 35
are available with communication
features for power management
and system software integration in 36
addition to a Web interface. Customers
and facility personnel can view the
metering data using a standard PC 37
Web browser. The new platform offers Voltage Presence Indicator (VoltageVision)
advanced functionality like transient
capture, high sampling rate, open Hardwired voltage detector 38
communications, Web server gate- connected to load side of disconnect
FlashGard Padlock Accessory
way, field-upgradable firmware, Enables operator to pre-verify
expandable memory and optional I/O. voltage presence with unit Locks out RotoTract operation 39
door closed during maintenance
Installable in a 30 mm pilot Allows operation of FlashGard units
device knockout by authorized personnel only
40
Dual redundant circuitry for Provided as standard on NEMA 12
reliability FlashGard MCCs (prevents dust 41
Phase insensitive entry into RotoTract access port)
Heavy-gauge steel construction
42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-14 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 016
General Description

22
Surge Protective DeviceSPD MCC Motor Control
Communication Choices
23 Table 29.1-2 is used to assist the user
in how each of the smart devices
communicates within the MCC. All
24 MCC communication solutions provide
for a single node per unit configura-
tion, eliminating any single point of
25 failure within the MCC. All networks
are industry accepted industrial
networks and allow for configuration,
26 monitoring and control of the end
node. A node is defined as a starter,
drive, soft start, breaker, meter or
27 other control device on the network.

28
SPD (Surge Protective Device) with
Circuit Breaker Disconnect
29 SPD Series units feature advanced
thermodynamic fusing technology and
are available in 18.00 inch (457.2 mm)
30 space factors. All units (100400 kA)
meet UL 1449, 3rd Edition. Internal fuse
31 protection is up to 200 kAIC.
Standard MCC offering includes
Monitoring Display with dual-colored
32 status LEDs. Optional surge counter,
Form C alarm contacts and audible
alarm enable/disable are also available.
33
Communications
34 Eatons motor control centers offer
the industrys most comprehensive Eatons Motor Control Centers

35 communications solutions in
motor control providing seamless
Table 29.1-2. Network Matrix
Network EtherNet/IP Modbus TCP DeviceNet PROFIBUS DP Modbus RTU
communicating on all major industry Protocol
36 standard field busses. Available with
communications to fit new and Physical layer Ethernet Ethernet Serial Serial Serial
existing applications, Eatons motor Node count Greater than Greater than 63 devices 32 devices per 32 devices per
37 control centers are custom-made 250, scanner
limited
250, scanner
limited
per network segment, 127 segment, 254
using repeaters using repeaters
assemblies of conveniently grouped
control equipment primarily used Speed (baud) 10/100 meg 10/100 meg 125/250/500 K 500 K to 12 meg Default 9600
38 for control of motors and power C306 starter C441U C441U C441K C441S C441N
distribution. (AC)
C440 starter C441U C441U C441K C441S C441N
Eaton motor control centers not only
39 are capable of communicating to the
(AC)
C441 starter C441R C441R C441K C441S C441N
industry standard protocols, they (AC)
also have the ability to serve up Web
40 pages, so any Web client can monitor
S811+ (AC) C441U C441U C441KS C441SS Onboard
and manage the MCC from any Feeder tap C441U C441U C441K C441S C441N
location accessible to the LAN. Remote IO C441U C441U C441K C441S C441N
41 Ordering the MCC with the Power (4 in 2 out)
Xpert Gateway provides the ability PXM series Gateway Onboard Gateway Gateway Onboard
to communicate information to the meters
42 Web as well as provides a seamless IQ series Gateway Gateway/ Gateway Gateway Onboard
interface between the low voltage, meters optional
onboard
medium voltage and all meters.
43 MP series MPONI + MPONI + MPONI + MPONI + MPONI
relays gateway gateway gateway gateway

Note: All MCCs are Power Xpert capable with the PXG gateway communicating to each bucket.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-15
January 2016
Sheet 29 017
General Description

Data Parameters Table 29.1-3. Data Parameters


To simplify system design and wiring Description Data Graphic 22
schemes, regardless of the industrial S811+ Soft Starts Line current (scaled/float)
network selected and the MCC family DeviceNet Average current (scaled/float) 23
selected, the nodes will be the same. Modbus Power pole temperatures
Depending on the type of smart device Modbus TCP % FLA (Running current/FLA setting)
PROFIBUS Thermal capacity
chosen, there will be varying types of
EtherNet/IP Fault/warning codes 24
data and control capability associated Field wiring status
with it. Each of the Eaton devices has a Handle position/breaker status
rich set of monitored data associated Ground fault current
Fault history
25
with it; consulting the user manual
may be needed to determine all Status (Run/Fault/Warn/Control/Aux...)
available data/parameters. SVX/DG1/MMX
AFDs
Speed (Hz)
Speed (rpm)
26
DeviceNet Torque
Modbus Current
Modbus TCP Voltage 27
PROFIBUS DC bus voltage temperature
EtherNet/IP Status (Run/Fault/Warn...)
Faults
Morerefer to manual
28
C441 IO Four AC inputs (DC is in an option)
DeviceNet (Running/Faulted/Breaker status, user denied)
PROFIBUS Two B300 relay outputs (Run) 29
Modbus
Modbus TCP
EtherNet/IP 30
C440 SSOL Line currents
DeviceNet % thermal remaining
PROFIBUS
Modbus
Faults
Ground current
31
Modbus TCP Status (Run/Fault/input/output)
EtherNet/IP Morerefer to manual
32
C441 SSOL Line currents
DeviceNet % thermal remaining 33
PROFIBUS % current unbalance
Modbus Line voltages
Modbus TCP
EtherNet/IP
% voltage unbalance
Faults
34
kW
Status (Run/Fault/input/output)
Morerefer to manual 35
MP-3000 Currents
MP-4000 Voltages
DeviceNet Power 36
PROFIBUS Energy
Modbus Much morerefer to manual
Modbus TCP
EtherNet/IP
37
PXM Meters Currents
Voltages
Power 38
Energy
Much morerefer to manual
39
Power Xpert Data depends on target device
Gateway Trending
to PowerNet Logging 40
Fault indication and more
Power Xpert Online diagnostics, troubleshooting,
Smart Gear documentation and monitoring
software solution.
41

42
Logic Control In a single unit, a PLC is provided for local
control of the MCC components.
43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-16 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 018
General Description

DeviceNet PROFIBUS DP MCC


22 DeviceNet is an industry standard field bus governed by
ODVA and is supported by most major vendors of PLC and
23 DSCs. DeviceNet, like most major field buses, provides
simplified control, increased diagnostics, reduced wiring
PROFIBUS

and data richness of the motor control centers. The Eaton


24 DeviceNet MCC solution provides users with significantly
reduced installation time and increased uptime through the
integration of intelligent devices and advanced software
25 tools. Control products include: ODVA compliant motor
starters, variable speed drives, operator interface, line
metering and block I/O.
26 DeviceNet in an MCC

27 PROFIBUS DP
DeviceNet
Eatons MCC use either a direct connect I/O block or direct
28 connect advanced solid-state overload relay to connect to
the PROFIBUS. The topology for PROFIBUS is daisy chain
and each device in the MCC will be daisy-chained together
29 to meet the PROFIBUS specification.
About PROFIBUS
Learn more about PROFIBUS by visiting the PROFIBUS
30 Trade Organization Association at profibus.com.

31 Ethernet
DeviceNet There are two supported protocols on Ethernet for the
Eaton MCC offeringEtherNet/IP (ODVA) and Modbus TCP
32 Eatons MCC use either a direct connect I/O block or direct (Modbus IDA), which are both industry standard field buses
connect advanced solid-state overload relay to connect to and supported by most major vendors of PLCs and DSCs.
DeviceNet. The topology is a trunk drop configuration where Ethernet, like most major field buses, provides simplified
33 the trunk runs along the top of the MCC and each device is control, increased diagnostics, reduced wiring and data
connected to DeviceNet via a drop cable running through the richness of the motor control centers. Another added benefit
vertical wireway. of Ethernet is that a PC can connect directly to the control
34 About DeviceNet
system and monitor the MCC from any location where
remote access is permitted. The Eaton Ethernet MCC
Learn more about DeviceNet by visiting the Open DeviceNet solution provides users with significantly reduced installa-
35 Vendor Association at odva.org. tion time and increased uptime through the integration of
intelligent devices and advanced software tools. Many of the
PROFIBUS DP Eaton control products such as the across-the-line starters,
36 PROFIBUS DP is an industry standard field bus governed by DG1 AFDs and S811+ communicate on Modbus TCP and
the PROFIBUS Trade Organization and is supported by most EtherNet/IP at the same time, allowing for a more flexible
major vendors of PLC and DSCs. PROFIBUS, like most major control and monitoring solution.
37 field buses, provides simplified control, increased diagnos-
Understanding Ethernet
tics, reduced wiring and data richness of the motor control
centers. The Eaton PROFIBUS MCC solution provides users Ethernet can be a very misunderstood word and confusing
38 with significantly reduced installation time and increased to someone who is trying to build a control or monitoring
uptime through the integration of intelligent devices and system and doesnt have much experience specifying this
advanced software tools. Control products include: motor type of communication. To help bring some clarity to how to
39 starters, variable speed drives, operator interface and specify Ethernet, this simple example is going to use an
block I/O. analogy that most of us are very familiar with. When you are
at home and pick up the phone to call a friend or neighbor,
40 your conversation is transmitted across a land line (wire)
that can be compared to Ethernet. In this example, both the
land line and the Ethernet are the physical medias in which
41 the communication is transmitted. When you call your
friends to communicate to them, you need to talk in a
language that is understood by each other; this language
42 is called the protocol, which is no different than Ethernet,
for the devices to communicate to each other they need to
support the same language or protocol. Modbus TCP and
43 EtherNet/IP are two widely supported protocols for Ethernet.
Modbus TCP is a standard founded by Modbus IDA and
natively supported by many major PLC and DCS vendors.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-17
January 2016 G
Sheet 29 019
General Description

EtherNet/IP is another standard that is founded by ODVA and Web-Enabled MCC


supported primarily by AB and other third-party vendors for
The Power Xpert Gateway provides Web-enabled, real-time
22
use in PLC and DCS applications. Now lets add another twist
to the example, lets say that you and a friend are talking in monitoring of electrical distribution and control equipment.
one protocol and then you conference in two friends that talk The Power Xpert Gateway makes integrating power equip- 23
another protocol. Using the same physical media, the four ment (up to 96 devices) onto an Ethernet network fast and
of you can all communicate to each other using multiple easy. The PXG is installed in a motor control center, low/
protocols. This is no different than Ethernet where the medium voltage switchgear or switchboard to consolidate 24
physical media supports both Modbus TCP and EtherNet/IP data available from components such as breakers, meters,
(and others) on the same physical media at the same time. motor controllers and protective relays. Through standard
onboard Web pages, Power Xpert Software or third-party 25
In the Eaton MCC when Ethernet is applied, there is a switch software, the PXG allows you to closely monitor the
in each shipping split and all the Ethernet devices for that performance of your power infrastructure with easily
split are then home run wired back to that switch. There accessed, real-time, Web-enabled data. In addition to 26
will be at least one customer connection per switch to make Web-enabling the components in the MCC, the PXG also
local connections or to connect to the control system. Over makes all the data available to upper level PLC, SCADA,
this Ethernet connection, not only can control and monitor- and BMS type systems over Modbus TCP, SNMP and 27
ing be performed, but also configuration of the end devices, BACnet/IP protocols.
allowing for easy access for maintenance personnel to the
equipment once they gain access to the Ethernet system. 28
Modbus TCP
There are two switch choices for the Eaton MCC: an
unmanaged switch (which is typical for Modbus TCP) and
a managed switch (which is required for EtherNet/IP). The
Power Xpert Gateway 29
managed switches can be connected in a redundant ring C440
network and only 600 V CAT 5 shielded Ethernet cable is C441 Modbus 485 RTU
used when connecting the devices to the switch and the S811+ 30
DG1 Any 485 RTU
switches together. SVX9000 device
For more information or clarity on the supported Ethernet PXM Meters 31
protocols and the products that support Ethernet, please call
877-ETN-CARE (877-386-2273) option 2. Figure 29.1-1. MCC ConfigurationModbus TCP
32
EtherNet/IP and Modbus TCP in a MCC Figure 29.1-1 through 29.1-6 represent typical Eaton
communications equipment found in MCCs. For more
Each Unit (Node)
Home Run Wired to
available equipment and configurations, please contact 33
Ethernet Switch
your local Eaton representative.

Power Xpert
34
Gateway

35

36

37

38
Modbus TCP and EtherNet/IP
39
About Ethernet
Power Xpert Architecture in an MCC
Learn more about EtherNet/IP by visiting the ODVA website
at odva.org. Learn more about Modbus TCP by visiting the 40
Modbus IDA website at modbus.org.
41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-18 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 020
General Description

22 Web

Power Xpert Gateway (Modbus TCP, SNMP, BACnet/IP and Webserver TCP/IP output)

23
Incom Modbus RTU 485

IPONI
24
C440 DT3000 ATC 400, 600, 800 MMX9000
C441 DT3200 IQ DP-4000 SVX9000
25 S811+ FP-4000 IQ Analyzer 6000/6200 DG1
PXM Meters FP-5000 IQ Analyzer 6400/6600 IQ 130
FP-6000 MP-3000 IQ 140
SMLD MP-4000 IQ 150
26 IQ 220/320/230/330 CMU IQ 220M/230M
IQES BIMII IQ 230M/330M
IQESU Universal RTD IQ 250
27 IQPSU
DIM
IQ Transfer IQ 260
EDR-3000
DT520MC, 810, 910, 1150 FP-5000
OPTIM Trip Units FP-6000
28 C440
C441
SqD 3000
29 SqD 4000
SqD PM710
SqD PM800
PML ION7350
30 PML ION7550
PML ION7650
GE 369
31 GE 469
Nexus 1262/1272
Qualitrol 118

32 Figure 29.1-2. MCC ConfigurationWeb-Enabled

33 Modbus RTU 485

34
RS485-PONI MMINT

IPONI
35
MMX9000 ATC 400, 600, 800 DT3000 ATC 400,600,800
SVX9000 IQ DP-4000 DT3200 IQ DP-4000
36 DG1
IQ 130
IQ Analyzer 6000/6200 FP-4000 IQ Analyzer 6000/6200
IQ Analyzer 6400/6600 FP-5000 IQ Analyzer 6400/6600
IQ 140 MP-3000 FP-6000 MP-3000
IQ 150 MP-4000 SMLD MP-4000
37 IQ 220M/230M CMU IQ 220/320/230/330 CMU
IQ 230M/330M IQ Transfer IQES BIMII
IQ 250 IQESU Universal RTD
38 IQ 260
EDR-3000
IQPSU
DIM
IQ Transfer

FP-5000 DT520MC, 810, 910, 1150


FP-6000 OPTIM Trip Units
39 C441
C440
PXM2000
40 PXM4000
PXM6000
PXM8000

41 Figure 29.1-3. MCC ConfigurationModbus 485 RTU

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-19
January 2016
Sheet 29 021
General Description

Power Xpert Smart Gear There is also a one-line that will represent a flat view of the
Eatons Power Xpert Smart Gear interface adds one more
MCC by power flow. Lastly the user has an option of group- 22
ing loads together to form several grouped one-lines that
layer of safety and diagnosis to any of the Eaton MCC can be 3 layers deep, which can be used to group loads of
products. The Power Xpert Smart Gear passively attaches a similar process for example. From the one-line, devices 23
(can be removed from the network or unplugged without that are faulted are easily seen and by selecting a device,
affecting the MCC communications) to the MCC Ethernet a favorites parameter list for that device is displayed.
network and performs a variety of functions including 24
monitoring, documentation, Maintenance Minder and alarms. The documentation view is an easy way to centralize user
The Power Xpert Smart Gear comes factory configured on manuals, troubleshooting tips, spare parts and electrical
a 15.00 inch (381.0 mm) screen. The software is written such drawings into one location per load. This information 25
that the application can be easily modified or changed by will be factory loaded and the user can choose to easily
the user to fit expansion or reconfiguration of the MCC by add or remove documents in the field. Having all the
any end user without any software or service contracts. wiring diagrams in one location on a large screen makes 26
troubleshooting easy as drawings will never get lost or
The Power Xpert Smart Gear views feature provides multiple be unreadable.
ways to look at the loads within the MCC. The views contain
an elevation of the MCC, a one-line view and the grouped Maintenance Minder is used to keep track of routine and
27
one-line. The default elevation will display the MCC as seen scheduled maintenance needed for all the devices in the
from the front, with each load identified and in a space that MCC. This will let the user know when a breaker needs to
is representative of the space it occupies in the MCC by be tripped per PM, how many cycles a contactor has used
28
section and location. By selecting a unit, a detailed view of and when to order new contacts, and other preventive
the unit will appear, which contains a trend along with the maintenance functions.
analog and discrete status of the device. Fault information
29
for the individual units are easily seen from this view. The alarm view will show all alarms and user-defined events
that occur. From this view, the user can acknowledge and
also Prado the alarms or events to assist in troubleshooting 30
and operating the equipment more efficiently.

31

32

33

34

35

36
Elevation View Oneline View
37
Figure 29.1-4. Power Xpert Smart Gear

38

39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-20 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 022
General Description

PLCs ELC PLC Monitoring and


22 Programmable controllers can be Configuration Tools
mounted in all styles of the Eaton MCCs For all the advanced MCC choices, a
23 in a wide variety of configurations.
Popular mounting configurations
tool is available to allow for configura-
tion and monitoring of the MCC and
include small PLCs (EZ) unit mounted its devices. The complimentary tool
24 to replace relays and timers, medium- located at www.eaton.com is called
sized PLCs with I/O for control of CH Studio, and is a Windows-based
an MCC lineup and also fieldbus ELC PLC configuration and monitoring package.
25 mastering capabilities to control over FlexibilityHandle I/O counts from
DeviceNet, Modbus or Modbus TCP. 10 I/O up to 256 I/O using a single CH Studio allows the user to custom
Due to the flexibility of PLCs and controller. ELCs eliminate the process configure I/O data for the starters
26 the wide variety of applications and of counting I/O and deciding which and drives, to verify loads and
configurations, the Eaton MCC is controller to use, as modules can easily configuration parameters, and to
designed to meet the mounting be added and removed as needed. ELC view the faults and operation status
27 requirements of most applications modules come in many flavors of I/O of the end devices. In addition to this,
to control not only the MCC but also from modules containing 4 in/4 out to CH Studio is also able to print out
auxiliary equipment not in the MCC. modules containing 8 in/8 out. ELC a detailed report for the system
28 EZ PLC controllers and modules mount to a programmer to use with designing
DIN rail, and the modules are added their program. To get an early start
by simply snapping them into the on the system design, CH Studio
29 mating connectors and closing the provided the ability to create the
attached locks. system offline and then synchronize
the offline settings to the online
30 Large PLC FeaturesInclude the system once the MCC arrives.
feature set of larger PLCs such as
multiple communication ports, remote
31 I/O, data storage, high-speed counters,
high-speed pulse outputs, interrupts,
timer resolution to 1 ms, PID, plus
32 much more. The ELC also has master-
ing capabilities to control DeviceNet,
EZ PLC Modbus and Modbus TCP slaves over
33 The EZ PLC is a timer and relay replacer an industrial network.
capable of being mounted directly
inside the MCC bucket and controlling Power of OneRegardless of the level
34 starters or other types of process of integration needed, Eaton MCCs
equipment. This small PLC comes provide an easy and comprehensive
in styles that have AC or DC I/O and solution to be part of a larger system
35 analog I/O, and also the ability to or be the entire system all by itself.
The Power Xpert gateway allows for
expand the I/O for larger I/O counts.
From the face of the EZ, a user can seamless integration into the Power
36 change set points and count values Xpert architecture, linking switchgear,
or other program values to easily meters and medium voltage assem-
manipulate the process it is controlling. blies. When the MCC is the control,
37 integrating the ELC with one of the
Eaton operator interface units and
communicating to starters, drives,
38 soft starts, meters and feeder breakers
is integrated into a clean, easy-to-
use solution.
39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-21
January 2016
Sheet 29 023
General Description

Clean Control Center with Active


Harmonic ControlTypical Layout Source Side Load Side 22
Harmonics Harmonics
The layout to the right is a typical Attenuated Present
arrangement for Eatons Clean Control 23
Center including harmonic correction
units for nonlinear loads such as
AC Variable Frequency Drives. The 24
horizontal bus of the Clean Control
Center is virtually free of harmonic
current content at the point where 25
the harmonic correction unit connects
to the bus. From this point to the
connection at the utility bus, the Clean 26
Control Center complies with the most
stringent requirements of IEEE 519 Main
and provides a clean waveform to the Breaker 27
upstream distribution system. Harmonic Panelboard Harmonic SVX9000 SVX9000 SVX9000 Starter
correction may be applied to loads Correction AC Drive AC Drive AC Drive
fed directly from the MCC (e.g., MCC
Unit 100A (30 hp) (150 hp) (250 hp)
28
mounted AC drives) or loads fed
indirectly from the MCC (e.g., MCC
mounted circuit breakers feeding SPD Surge 29
remote drives). Multiple correction Protection
Module Distribution
units may be used to achieve the level Transformer
of harmonic correction as required by
SVX9000
30
the amount of nonlinear loads within AC Drive Starter
the MCC lineup. (30 hp)

Starter
31

32
20.00 24.00 24.00 20.00 20.00 28.00 20.00
(508.0) (609.6) (609.6) (508.0) (508.0) (711.2) (508.0)
33
Figure 29.1-5. Clean Control Center with Active Harmonic ControlDimensions in Inches (mm)
Note: As seen by the upstream electrical systemcompliance to the most stringent
standards of IEEE 519 is ensured.
34

Harmonic Correction Non-Linear Load(s)


35
The Clean Control Center uses a
harmonic correction unit to provide SVX
harmonic cancellation directly on the
36
motor control center horizontal bus. Source
The harmonic correction unit senses Typical CT
the load current and injects into the AC
XFMR Placement SVX 37
lines a synthesized waveform that is
inverted compared to the remaining 38
signal. The result is a clean waveform
as seen by the upstream electrical SVX
system. Single or multiple harmonic 39
correction units may be applied within Alternate CT
Harmonic
a Clean Control Center providing an Placement
Correction SVX
economical solution to excessive Unit 40
harmonics due to AC drives or other
nonlinear loads. Use of the Clean
Figure 29.1-6. Clean Control Center Installation Diagram
Control Center will provide compliance
to the most stringent 5% Total Demand
41
Distortion (TDD) requirements of IEEE
519. Clean Control Center assemblies 42
include a 24.00-inch (609.6 mm) wide
MCC structure, active harmonic correc-
tion unit, current transformers and a 43
door-mounted digital interface panel.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-22 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 024
General Description

Solid-State Motor Protection


22

23

24
C441 Overload Relays
25
The C441 Motor Insight is a micro-
processor-based solid-state overload
26 relay providing superior motor protec-
tion, communications and motor EMR 3000 Relay
monitoring features. This overload
27 C440/XT Electronic Overload Relay
provides the standard set of protec-
The EMR 3000 motor overcurrent relay
is a microprocessor-based relay that
Eatons C440 and C441 solid-state tions that includes I2t, jam, stall and
provides superior motor protection
overload relay offers improved motor phase protections. The C441 also
28 protection due to high repeat accuracy provides ground fault, phase reversal,
for critical process motors. Standard
protective features provided in the
and fast reaction times to phase failures. voltage unbalance, programmable trip
EMR 3000 include: I2t, programmable
The state-of-the-art microelectronics class, trip history, thermal capacity,
29 design permits the choice of relays power factor and voltage, current and
locked rotor protection, instantaneous
overcurrent, ground fault, under load,
with different trip classes (Class 5, 10, power monitoring. With the simple
jam, phase loss/unbalance/reversal,
20, 30) to accommodate motors with addition of a communication module,
30 a variety of application needs. the C441 is capable of communicating
limit starts per hour, alarm and trip
modes, and the capability to use motor
to one of the following industrial
The C440 solid-state overloads are RTD for motor protection. Functions
field busses: DeviceNet, Modbus
31 available on all Freedom starter sizes. RTU, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP or
are user programmable via local or
(Size 5 and up use CTs with the overload remote data entry and display panel
Modbus TCP.
relay.) Key features include: mounted in the door of the MCC. For
32 Phase loss
Key features of C441 Motor Insight further details, refer to Tab 4.
communicating overloads include:
Phase imbalance
33 DeviceNet, Modbus, PROFIBUS and
Wide adjustment range
Ethernet communication options
Low energy usage
Three-phase voltage monitoring
Reduced heat
34 Three-phase current monitoring
With the simple addition of a communi- kWh usage indication
cation module, the C440 is capable of Motor power factor indication
35 communicating to one of the following
Last four faults history
industrial field busses: DeviceNet,
Modbus RTU, PROFIBUS, EtherNet/IP Optional remote mounted display
36 or Modbus TCP. I/O communication adapter with EMR 4000 Relay
four inputs and two outputs The EMR 4000 motor overload relay
Programmable set points, including:
37 Low voltage set point
provides a higher level in motor
protection. In addition to all the
High voltage set point protective features included in the
38 Voltage unbalance set point
EMR 3000, the EMR 4000 also includes
voltage-based protection/metering as
CT multiplier/ratio settings well: undervoltage, negative sequence,
39 Overcurrent set point power factor, overvoltage, over/under
frequency and forward/reverse power.
Current unbalance trip point
For further details, refer to Tab 4.
Trip Class (5, 10, 15, 20, 30,
40 and/or Jam)
Rapid cycle timer
41 Restart delay timer
Underload restart delay timer
42 Number of restarts after faults
(Manual/Auto)
Undercurrent trip delay
43 Ground fault trip set point

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.1-23
January 2016
Sheet 29 025
General Description

Additional Services Maintenance and


22
Operational Training
Startup Assistance A full range of training and operational
To ensure complete customer training programs are available for all 23
satisfaction and to expedite equipment types of MCC-mounted equipment.
startup for motor control centers, this In addition, preventative maintenance
service provides a factory-trained programs are available to ensure years 24
representative at the job site during of trouble-free operation.
equipment energization. This service
is provided on a fixed price basis. In Retrofits 25
addition to factory directed startup,
Existing installations can many times
the standard equipment warranty is
benefit from some of the new
extended for a period of 24 months.
technology equipment available
26
This service is especially beneficial
in todays MCCs. Eaton offers a full
when solid-state equipment is
range of retrofit capabilities to upgrade
incorporated within the MCC due to
existing MCC lineups. Examples
27
the flexibility in adjusting solid-state
include: vacuum contactors, reduced
equipment for each application.
voltage solid-state starters, solid-state 28
metering and solid-state overload
protection. Starter retrofit kits for
selective competitor MCCs are also 29
available. Consult factory for availability.

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.1-24 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 026

This page intentionally left blank.


22

23

24

25

26

27

28

29

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-1
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 027
Layout and Technical Data

Standard Structures and at the top and at the bottom and a


22
4.00-inch (101.6 mm) wide full height 16.00 (406.4)
Structure Options vertical wireway at the right. All wireway
doors are hinged and secured with
The standard Freedom, Freedom Arc 1/4-turn latches. The standard busing is 23
and Freedom FlashGard structure is 600 A, UL rated, copper horizontal bus
NEMA 1, gasketed, 90.00 inches (2286.0 and 300 A, UL rated, copper vertical bus 90.00
mm) high, 20.00 inches (508.0 mm) wide braced for 65,000 symmetrical amperes.
(2286.0)
24
with a depth as shown in Figure 29.2-1. Many other bus sizes and types are
Each standard structure has a 9.00-inch available. Also included as standard
(228.6 mm) high horizontal wireway is a vertical bus isolation barrier. 25
Table 29.2-1. Standard Structures and Structure OptionsDimensions in Inches (mm) 1
Description 20.00
(508.0)
26
Standard Structures
Structure 1 6
16.00 (406.4) deep structure 2 Structure 1 72-inch (1828.8 mm) Space
21.00 (533.4) deep structure Front Mounted Only 27
Front mounting only Structure 2
Front and rear mounting 2 Structure 3
4.00 (101.6) of additional structure width, 32.00 (812.8) maximum 2
8.00 (203.2) vertical wireway in lieu of standard 4.00-inch (101.6) 21.00 (533.4) 28
Special Structures
Single corner section for L configuration of MCC
Transition section 2 29
Series 2100 to Type W
10.00 (254.0) widefront aligned
Plug-in blank relay mounting space, per 6-inch
Fixed-mounted relay back pan, full depth of structure
Any 6.00 (152.4) height
30
20.00 (508.0) structure with wireway 13.00 (330.2) with usable panel
24.00 (609.6) structure with wireway 17.00 (431.8) with usable panel
28.00 (711.2) structure with wireway
20.00 (508.0) structure without wireway
21.00 (533.4) with usable panel
17.00 (431.8) with usable panel
31
24.00 (609.6) structure without wireway 21.00 (533.4) with usable panel
28.00 (711.2) structure without wireway 25.00 (635.0) with usable panel
32.00 (812.8) with double door 2 20.00
(508.0)
32
36.00 (914.4) with double door 2
40.00 (1016.0) with double door 2 Structure 2 6
Relay Structures
(per complete structure with full fixed mounting back pan)
72-inch (1828.8 mm) Space
Front Mounted Only
33
20.00 (508.0) structure with wireway Complete section
24.00 (609.6) structure with wireway Complete section
28.00 (711.2) structure with wireway
20.00 (508.0) structure without wireway
Complete section
Complete section 21.00 (533.4)
34
Top Horizontal
24.00 (609.6) structure without wireway Complete section Wireway
28.00 (711.2) structure without wireway Complete section
Plexiglass see-through door insert for PLC structure 6.00 (152.4) increments Vertical
Wireway
35
19.00 (482.6) instrumentation mounting racks installed
in relay structure Consult Eaton
1
2
This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom FlashGard MCCs. 36
Not available in Freedom Arc.
Vertical
Table 29.2-2. Structure ModificationsDimensions in Inches (mm) 3 Compartment

Channel floor sills: 11-gauge, 1.00 x 3.00 (25.4 x 76.2) 37


NEMA 1 gasket Bottom
Horizontal
NEMA 12 dust-proof, includes bottom plate 4 Wireway
Bottom plate for NEMA 1 gasketed enclosure
150-watt space heater, per structure 20.00
38
Thermostat for space heater control (508.0)
Pullbox kit for cable and wiring to be field mounted on top structure 4 Structure 3
12.00 (304.8) high 72-inch (1828.8 mm) SpaceFront 39
18.00 (457.2) high 66-inch (1676.4 mm) SpaceRear
24.00 (609.6) high Back-to-Back
Rear hinged structure door, 72.00 (1828.8) high 4
NEMA 2 drip shield on top of MCC 4
40
NEMA 3R non-walk-infront-mounted, back-to-back 4 Figure 29.2-1. StructureDimensions in
NEMA 3R walk-in aisle-front mounted 4 Inches (mm)
NEMA 3R walk-in tunnel type 4
6
41
NEMA 4Xconsult factory 4 The standard Freedom Series structure is
Special reduced height structures 4 designed to comply with the UL 2-meter
Seismic certification (earthquake qualification) requirement. Disconnect operating handle
UL handle extension 5 is not more than 2 meters [78.00 inches 42
3 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom FlashGard MCCs. (1981.2 mm)] above the bottom of the
4 MCC. Motor control centers elevated on
Not available in Freedom Arc.
5 The standard Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom FlashGard Series structure is designed to
a raised pad or installed on unembedded 43
channel sills may require operator handle
comply with the UL 2-meter requirement. Disconnect operating handle is not more than 2 meters extensions for the uppermost operators.
[78.00 inches (1981.2 mm)] above the bottom of the MCC. Motor control centers elevated on a UL handle extension optionally available
raised pad or installed on unembedded channel sills may require operator handle extensions for when required.
the uppermost operators. UL handle extension optionally available when required.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-2 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 028
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.2-3. Bus ModificationsDimensions in Inches (mm) 1


22 Eatons Freedom Series MCCs bear the UL label. Service entrance labeling is available.
Description

23 Main Bus, Per Vertical Structure CuTin-Plated


(Standard)
Copper Horizontal Bus Ratings Tin-Plated 50 C 65 C

600 A Size 0.25 x 2.00 (6.4 x 50.8)Bars/Phase 1 0.25 x 2.00 (6.4 x 50.8)Bars/Phase 1
24 800 A Size 0.25 x 3.00 (6.4 x 76.2)Bars/Phase 1 0.25 x 2.00 (6.4 x 50.8)Bars/Phase 1
1200 A Size 0.25 x 2.50 (6.4 x 63.5)Bars/Phase 2 0.25 x 3.00 (6.4 x 76.2)Bars/Phase 1
1600 A Size 0.25 x 3.00 (6.4 x 76.2)Bars/Phase 4 0.25 x 3.00 (6.4 x 76.2)Bars/Phase 2 21.00 (533.4) deep 3
25 2000 A Size
2500 A Size
0.25 x 2.50 (6.4 x 63.5)Bars/Phase 6
0.25 x 3.00 (6.4 x 76.2)Bars/Phase 8 2
0.25 x 2.50 (6.4 x 63.5)Bars/Phase 4
0.25 x 3.00 (6.4 x 76.2)Bars/Phase 6
21.00 (533.4) deep 3
21.00 (533.4) deep 4
3200 A Size 2 N/A 0.25 x 3.00 (6.4 x 76.2)Bars/Phase 8 21.00 (533.4) deep 45

26 Silver-plated bus main horizontal bus


Insulated main horizontal bus, per vertical structure (taping)
Optional
Optional
Vertical bus, per vertical structure: 300 Acopper (tin-plated) Standard 6
Increased bus capacity: rated at 600 A (front-mounted only) Cu only
27 Rated at 600 A (back-to-back)copper Standard
Rated at 800 A (back-to-back and front) Cu only
Rated at 1200 A Cu only
28 Increased mechanical bus bracing, per vertical structure:
42,000 A rms symmetrical short-circuit current Optional
65,000 A rms symmetrical short-circuit current Standard
100,000 A rms symmetrical short-circuit current 2 Optional
29 Vertical bus isolation barrier, per vertical structure Standard
Labyrinth design insulation-isolation vertical bus barrier Optional Freedom
Ground bus, 300 A standard, per vertical structure Standard Cu
30 Increased capacity ground bus only, 600 A, 1/4- x 2.00-inch (6.4 x 50.8 mm), per vertical structure
FlashGard plug-in grounding system, includes 300 A vertical ground bus and unit grounding clips, per vertical structure
Standard Cu
Cu
Neutral bus, ungrounded for three-phase, four-wire power, per vertical structure 7 Cu
Splice plates
31 1 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom FlashGard MCCs.
2 Not available in Freedom Arc.
3 Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep structure.
32 4 Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep structure. Not available in back-to-back structure.
5 Contact Eaton for 3200 A dimensions.
6 Vertical bus and unit stabs are tin-plated copper only.
33 7 Neutral is half-rating of horizontal bus.

Table 29.2-4. Main Lugs OnlyMechanical Lug Compartment (Three-Phase, Three- or Four-wire)Dimensions in Inches (mm) 8
34 Provisions for terminating incoming line cables directly onto the MCC bus system. Up to 1200 A, all lug landings are bolted to
a fully rated vertical bus in that section. MLO sections must be put at the top for top entry cables and at the bottom for bottom
entry cables. For smaller cable sizes, cable lugs may also be extended into an optional top hat as shown in this table.
35 Maximum Cable Bus Rating Maximum Cables Cable Entry Lug Unit X Enclosure
Size (kcmil) (Amperes) per Phase (Top or Bottom) Type Space Space 9 Width

350 600 2 Screw 12.00 (304.8) 2X 20.00 (508.0)


36 Crimp 18.00 (457.2) 3X
4 Top Screw 18.00 (457.2) 3X
Screw 24.00 (609.6) 4X
37 Bottom Crimp 36.00 (914.4) 6X
18.00-inch (457.2 mm) Either
top hat
38 600 800 2 Screw 18.00 (457.2) 3X
Crimp 24.00 (609.6) 4X
4 Screw 24.00 (609.6) 4X
39 Crimp 36.00 (914.4) 6X
18.00-inch (457.2 mm) Either
top hat
40 750 1000 2
2
Screw
Crimp
24.00 (609.6)
36.00 (914.4)
4X
6X
4 Screw 36.00 (914.4) 6X
4 Crimp 48.00 (1219.2) 8X
41 1000 1200 2 Screw 30.00 (762.0) 5X
Crimp 36.00 (914.4) 6X
1000 1600 8 Screw 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
42 Crimp 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
1000 2500 8 Screw 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
Crimp 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
43 3200 Screw 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
Crimp 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
8 This table is common for the Freedom and Freedom FlashGard. Freedom Arc Resistant does not contain an MLO option.
9 Requires 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) = (1X) unit space.
j Lug landings require the complete vertical section. The rear is unusable.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-3
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 029
Layout and Technical Data

Bus Duct Entry Sandwich Type to Horizontal Bus or Main Table 29.2-6. Typical Heat Loss Data 3
DisconnectPull Box Description Current (A) Loss (W) 22
Pull box and pre-fabricated bus connectors are supplied to
Vertical Sections 600 200
match the sandwich type bus duct end flange. Bus duct is
assumed to enter the top. Bus duct type and orientation to
Horizontal Bus and
Ampacity
800
1200
300
500
23
the MCC must be provided. 1600 700
2000 1000
Table 29.2-5. Bus Duct Entry to Horizontal Bus or Main Disconnect 2500 1400 24
Pull BoxDimensions in Inches (mm) 1 3200 2050
Horizontal Bus Pull Box
Rating (Amperes) Height Space Heaters Loss (W)
25
6001600 18.00 (457.2) Space heaters 500
20002500 2
1
24.00 (609.6)
26
This table is common for both Freedom and Freedom Loss (W)
FlashGard MCCs; Freedom Arc does not have this option.
Starters C306 C440/C441
2 Contact Eaton for 3200 A dimensions.
Note: Consult factory for non-segregated bus requirements. FVNR size 1 40 30 27
FVNR size 2 60 50
FVNR size 3 100 90
FVNR size 4 130 120 28
FVNR size 5 230 220
FNVR size 6 400 390
29
AFDs
SVX DG1 hp (VT) Loss (W)
FR4 FR1 7.5 140 30
FR5 FR2 20 400
FR6 FR3 40 800
FR7
FR8
FR4
FR4
75
150
1400
2800
31
FR9 250 4000
FR10 400 6250
32
Power Breakers Amps Loss (W)
MDN-608 (Fixed) 800 45 33
MDN-612 (Fixed) 1200 110
MDN-616 (Fixed) 1600 180
MDS-C08 (Drawout) 800 60
MDS-C16 (Drawout) 1600 240 34
MDS-C20 (Drawout) 2000 380
MDS-C32 (Drawout) 3200 800
35
Series C Molded Case Breakers Amps Loss (W)
FD
KD
150
400
60
175
36
LD 600 225
ND 800 87
ND 1200 210 37
RK 1600 220
RD 2000 270
RD 2500 400
38
Series G Molded Case Breakers Amps Loss (W)
EG 125 50 39
JG 250 75
LG 600 225
NG
NG
800
1200
87
210
40
RG 1600 220
RG 2000 270
RG 2500 400 41
3 The starters are using the C306 bi-metal overload relay.

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-4 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 030
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.2-7. Typical Weights in lbs (kg) 1 Table 29.2-8. Control Power Transformer Data 3
22 Description Weight All control power transformers are encapsulated and will
deliver rated secondary voltage at full load. Two primary
16.00-inch (406.4 mm) deep x 20.00-inch 200 (91) and one secondary fuses are furnished as standard.
23 (508.0 mm) wide structure 2
NEMA Size Starter Type Freedom
21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep x 20.00-inch 260 (118) Starter Standard Maximum 4
(508.0 mm) wide structure 2
VA Rating VA Rating
24 Adder for Horizontal Bus
Size 1 Full voltage 100 150
800 A 10 (5) Size 1 5 non-reversing 100 100
1000 A 15 (7)
25 1200 A 18 (8)
Size 2
Size 2 5
and reversing 100
N/A
150
N/A
1600 A 24 (11) Size 3 150 250
2000 A 30 (14) Size 4 200 250
26 2500 A 38 (17) Size 5 200 350
3200 A 49 (22) Size 6 150 250
Adder for Vertical Bus Size 2 Autotransformer 100 150
27 Size 3 150 250
600 A 30 (14) Size 4 200 250
800 A 40 (18) Size 5 250 350
1200 A 60 (27)
28 Size 6 200 350
Adder for Units FreedomInches (mm) Size 1 Two-speed 100 200
Size 2 One winding 100 200
12.00 (304.8) 25 (11.4)
Size 3 200 250
29 18.00 (457.2) 40 (18)
Size 4 350 500
24.00 (609.6) 63 (29)
Size 5 350 500
30.00 (762.0) 77 (35) Size 6 200 350
30 36.00 (914.4) 100 (45) Size 1 Two-speed 100 150
1 Example: 21.00 inches deep NEMA 1, 2000 A horizontal bus, Size 2 Two winding 100 150
600 A vertical bus, two Size 1 starters, one Size 3 starter. Size 3 150 250
31 2
260 + 30 + 30 + (2 x 25) + 40 = 410 lbs Size 4
Size 5
200
200
250
250
Weight for NEMA 1 structure with 600 A horizontal and 300 A
vertical bus. Size 6 200 350

32 Size 1
Size 2
Part winding 150
150
150
150
Size 3 200 250
Size 4 350 500
33 Size 5 350 500
Size 6 200 350
Size 2 Wye delta 200 200
34 Size 3 (open or closed 350 200
Size 4 transition) 350 500
Size 5 200 500
Size 6 200 350
35 3 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
FlashGard MCCs.
4 Maximum size without increasing starter space.
36 5 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) unit.

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-5
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 031
Layout and Technical Data

Motor Protection Table 29.2-9. Motor Circuit Protector (MCP), Circuit Breaker and Fusible Switch Selection Guide
In line with 2005 NEC 430.6(A) circuit Horsepower Full Load Fuse Size NEC 430.52 Circuit Breaker 22
Amperes Maximum Circuit Motor Circuit
breaker, HMCP and fuse rating selec- (NEC) FLA Amperes
tions are based on full load currents Breaker Protector Type HMCP
for induction motors running at Time Delay Non-Time Delay Amperes Type Amperes Adj. Range
23
speeds normal for belted motors and 230 Volts, Three-Phase
motors with normal torque character- 1 3.6 10 15 15 HFD 7 2170 24
istics using data taken from NEC Table 1-1/2 5.2 10 20 15 HFD 15 45150
130.250 (three-phase). Actual motor 2 6.8 15 25 15 HFD 15 45150
3 9.6 20 30 20 HFD 30 90300
nameplate ratings shall be used for 25
selecting motor running overload 5 15.2 30 50 30 HFD 30 90300
protection. Motors built special for low 7-1/2 22 40 70 50 HFD 50 150500
10 28 50 90 60 HFD 50 150500
speeds, high torque characteristics, 15 42 80 150 90 HFD 100 3001000 26
special starting conditions and applica-
20 54 100 175 100 HFD 100 3001000
tions will require other considerations 25 68 125 225 125 HFD 150 4501500
as defined in the application section of 30 80 150 250 150 HFD 150 4501500 27
the NEC. 40 104 200 350 150 HFD 150 7502500
50 130 250 400 200 HFD 150 7502500
These additional considerations may
require the use of a higher rated HMCP,
60 154 300 500 225 HFD 250 12502500 28
75 192 350 600 300 HKD 400 20004000
or at least one with higher magnetic 100 248 450 800 400 HKD 400 20004000
pickup settings. 125
150
312
360
600
700
1000
1200
500
600
HLD
HLD
600
600
18006000
18006000
29
Circuit breaker, HMCP and fuse 200 480 1000 1600 700 HND 600 18006000
ampere rating selections are in line
with maximum rules given in NEC
460 Volts, Three-Phase 30
430.52 and Table 430.250. Based on 1 1.8 6 6 15 HFD 7 2170
1-1/2 2.6 6 10 15 HFD 7 2170
known characteristics of Eaton type
breakers, specific units are recom-
2
3
3.4
4.8
6
10
15
15
15
15
HFD
HFD
7
15
2170
45150
31
mended. The current ratings are no 15 7.6 15 25 15 HFD 15 45150
more than the maximum limits set 7-1/2 11 20 35 25 HFD 30 90300
by the NEC rules for motors with code 10 14 25 45 35 HFD 30 90300 32
letters F to V or without code letters. 15 21 40 70 45 HFD 50 150500
Motors with lower code letters will 20 27 50 90 50 HFD 50 150500
require further considerations. 25 34 60 110 70 HFD 70 210700 33
30 40 70 125 70 HFD 100 3001000
In general, these selections were 40 52 100 175 100 HFD 100 3001000
based on: 50 65 125 200 110 HFD 150 4501500 34
60 77 150 150 125 HFD 150 7502500
1. AmbientOutside enclosure not 75 96 175 300 150 HJD 150 7502500
more than 40 C (104 F). 100 124 225 400 175 HJD 150 7502500
35
125 156 300 500 225 HKD 400 20004000
2. Motor startingInfrequent 150 180 350 600 250 HJD 400 20004000
starting, stopping or reversing. 200 240 450 800 350 L600 600 18006000
575 Volts, Three-Phase
36
3. Motor accelerating time
10 seconds or less. 1 1.4 3 6 15 HFD 3 930

4. Locked rotorMaximum 6 times


1-1/2
2
2.1
2.7
6
6
10
10
15
15
HFD
HFD
7
7
2170
2170
37
motor FLA. 3 3.9 10 15 15 HFD 7 2170
15 6.1 15 20 15 HFD 15 45150
Type HMCP motor circuit protector 7-1/2 9 20 30 20 HFD 30 90300
38
may not set at more than 1300% of the 10 11 20 35 25 HFD 30 90300
motor full-load current to comply with 15 17 30 60 40 HFD 30 90300
NEC 430.52. (Except for NEMA Design 20 22 40 70 50 HFD 50 150500 39
B energy high-efficiency motors which 25 27 50 90 60 HFD 50 150500
can be set up to 1700%.) 30 32 60 100 60 HFD 70 210500
40 41 80 125 80 HFD 100 3001000 40
Circuit breaker selections are based 50 52 100 175 100 HFD 100 3001000
on types with standard interrupting 60 62 110 200 125 HFD 150 7502500
ratings. Higher interrupting rating types 75
100
77
99
150
175
250
300
150
175
HFD
HJD
150
150
7502500
7502500
41
may be required to satisfy specific
system application requirements. 125 125 225 400 200 HJD 250 12502500
150 144 300 450 225 HJD 250 12502500
For motor full load currents of 208 and 200 192 350 600 300 HKD 400 20004000 42
200 volts, increase the corresponding
230-volt motor values by 10 and 15%
respectively.
43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-6 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 032
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.2-10. Starter Sizes Selection Guide 1


22 Squirrel-Cage 230 V, Three-Phase 460 V, Three-Phase 575 V, Three-Phase
Motor Control Center Full Load 2 Wire Size 3 Control Center Full Load 2 Wire Size 3 Control Center Full Load 2 Wire Size 3
Horsepower Starter NEMA Current at 75 C Max. Starter NEMA Current at 75 C Max. Starter NEMA Current at 75 C Max.
23 Size Amperes at 40 C Amb. Size Amperes at 40 C Amb. Size Amperes at 40 C Amb.

1/2 1 2.2 14 1 1.1 14 1 0.9 14


3/4 1 3.2 14 1 1.6 14 1 1.3 14
24 1 1 4.2 14 1 2.1 14 1 1.7 14
1-1/2 1 6.0 14 1 3.0 14 1 2.4 14
2 1 6.8 14 1 3.4 14 1 2.7 14
25 3
5
1
1
9.6
15.2
14
12
1
1
4.8
7.6
14
14
1
1
3.9
6.1
14
14
7-1/2 1 22 10 1 11 14 1 9 14
10 2 28 10 1 14 14 1 11 14
26 15 2 42 8 2 21 10 2 17 12
20 3 54 6 2 27 10 2 22 10
25 3 68 4 2 34 8 2 27 10
27 30
40
3
4
80
104
3
1
3
3
40
52
8
6
3
3
32
41
8
8
50 4 130 1/0 3 65 4 3 52 6
60 5 154 3/0 4 77 3 4 62 4
28 75 5 192 4/0 4 96 2 4 77 3
100 5 248 300 kcmil 4 124 1/0 4 99 2
125 6 312 500 kcmil 5 156 3/0 5 125 1/0
150 6 360 24/0 5 180 4/0 5 144 2/0
29 200 6 480 2300 kcmil 5 240 300 kcmil 5 192 4/0
250 4 6 302 500 kcmil 6 242 300 kcmil
300 4 6 361 24/0 6 289 400 kcmil
30 1 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom 3 Information is based on use of copper conductorsTable 310.16 and

FlashGard MCCs. Tables 1, 4 and 5, Ch. 9 of NEC. If aluminum conductors are used refer
2 Information is based on Table 430.150 of NEC (1999). to Table 310.16 of NEC (1999).
31 4 Not available in Freedom Arc.

Dimensions in Inches (mm)


32
12.12 Horizontal Bus Location 12.12
(307.8) (307.8) Horizontal Bus Location
Location of Location of
10.50 Vertical Bus Location Ground Bus 10.50
Ground Bus Vertical Bus Location
33 (266.7)
3.12 (79.2)
(266.7) Removable Bus Barrier 
3.12 (79.2)
2.25 A 4.62 (117.3) A
(57.2) 2.25 4.62 (117.3) 15.00
(57.2) (381.0)
34 
4.62 (117.3) 4.62 (117.3)
Front Horizontal
Front Horizontal Wireway
Wireway 7.16 Removable Rear Horizontal Wireway
Bus Barrier 7.16 (181.9) Deep C 4.97 (126.2) Deep
(181.9) Deep
35 
Flat Rear Cover


Supplied on Front
Mounted Only 
Structure
36 Minimum Rated Vertical
Bus Supplied as Standard
in Front Mounted Only D
Structure 
37 





B
38 Floor Line
B
5.00 (127.0) Floor Line E 5.00 (127.0)
3-inch (76.2 mm) Channel Sills 3-inch (76.2 mm) Channel Sills
9.73 (247.14) Supplied Only When Specified 1.00 (25.4) 9.73 (247.14) 3.00 Supplied Only When Specified
3.00 or 14.11 (358.4)
1.00 or 14.11 (358.4)
(76.2) (76.2)
39 (25.4) 20.11 (510.8)
or 15.73 (399.5)
20.11 (510.8)
or 15.73 (399.5)

10.50 10.50 Location of Neutral Bus


Location of Neutral Bus (266.7)
(266.7) When Specified When Specified

40 Figure 29.2-2. Side View AFront Mounted Only Figure 29.2-3. Side View BFront and Rear Mounted
5 7 Master terminal block assembly furnished for Type C wiring only. When
Master terminal block assembly furnished for Type C wiring only. When
location not specified, MTB supplied at the bottom. location not specified, MTB supplied at the bottom.
41 6 Standard structure arrangement in front 8 Rear horizontal bus barrier not supplied with front mounted only structure.
Without MTB; A and B = 9.00 inches (228.6 mm) 9 Standard structure arrangement in front
With MTB at bottom; A and B = 9.00 inches (228.6 mm) Without MTB; A and B = 9.00 inches (228.6 mm)
42 With MTB at top; A = 15.00 inches (381.0 mm), With MTB at bottom; A and B = 9.00 inches (228.6 mm)
B = 3.00 inches (76.2 mm) With MTB at top; A = 15.00 inches (381.0 mm), B = 3.00 inches (76.2 mm)
j Standard structure arrangement in rear
43 Without MTB; C = 9.00 inches (228.6 mm),
D = 72.00 inches (1828.8 mm), E = 3.00 inches (76.2 mm)
With MTB at bottom; C = 0, D = 66.00 inches (1676.4 mm),
E = 9.00 inches (228.6 mm)
With MTB at top; C = 12.00 inches (304.8 mm),
Not to be used for construction purposes unless approved. D = 60.00 inches (1524.0 mm), E = 3.00 inches (76.2 mm)

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-7
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 033
Layout and Technical Data

19.60 22
(497.8)

23

24

25
0.00

26
28.00
0.00
(711.2) 19.60
0.00 (497.8) 27
0.00
28

9.73
29
(247.1)

30
17.23
(437.6)
31
Location of relay backpan
18.60 (472.4) from front
32

33

34

35
47.23
(1199.6)
36

37

38

39

40
77.23
(1961.6)
41

42
90.00
(2286.0)
43
Figure 29.2-4. Relay Structure (28.00 inches [711.2 mm] wide and 20.00 inches [508.0 mm] deep shown)

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-8 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 034
Layout and Technical Data

Dimensions in Inches (mm)


22
1 Minimum length of anchor bolt
3.50 3.50 2.00 inches (50.8 mm) 0.36 inches
23 (88.9) (88.9) Removable
Top Cover
2
(9.1 mm)16 recommended.
Top Conduit Recommended maximum conduit height
Space above floor line 3.50 inches (88.9 mm).
24 16.00
3 Maximum conduit space with channel sills
17.50 x 9.73 inches (444.5 x 247.1 mm).
(406.4)
5.41 4 For multiple structure assemblies. Either one
(137.4) or both of these members are removed to
25 provide maximum unrestricted conduit space
2.20 Vertical Wireway at bottom. Not to be removed for seismic.
(55.9) Door 5 This conduit space not recommended when
26 1.25
17.50
(444.5) 1.25
6
neutral bus required. Otherwise available.
(31.8) (31.8) Top rear conduit space not recommended
Wire Tie for conduit entry in FMO structure.
20.00 Brackets
27 (508.0)
See Side View A Page 29.2-6 for
7.31
1.25
17.50 1.25 (185.7) vertical dimensions.
(31.8) (31.8)
28 
(444.5)
4.81
Vertical
Wireway
Removable Bottom (122.2)
5.41 Frame Members 
(137.4)
29 13.97
(354.8)
6.81
(173.0) Bottom Conduit Space 

30 1.58 .70
(40.1) (17.8)
16.00 2.00
.53 Dia.
(406.4) (50.8)
31 .53 Dia.

Figure 29.2-5. 20.00 Inches (508.0 mm) Wide, 16.00 Inches (406.4 mm)
32 Deep-Front Mounted Only (FMO)

33
3.50 3.50
(88.9) (88.9) Removable
Top Cover
34
Top Conduit 
Space

35 20.38
(517.7)
5.41
(137.4)

36
2.20 Vertical Wireway
(55.9) Door
17.50
37 1.25
(31.8)
(444.5) 1.25
(31.8)
20.00
(508.0) Wire Tie
Brackets
38 1.25
7.31
17.50 1.25 (185.7)
(31.8) (444.50) (31.8)
 Vertical
39 5.41
Removable Bottom
Frame Members 
4.81
(122.2)
Wireway
(137.4)
18.35
5.78 (466.1)
40 (146.8)
Bottom Conduit Space 
5.41
(137.4)

41 1.58 .70
(40.1) (17.8)
16.00 2.00
.53 Dia.
(406.4) (50.8)
42 .53 Dia.

Figure 29.2-6. 20.00 Inches (508.0 mm) Wide, 21.00 Inches (533.4 mm)
43 Deep-Front Mounted Only (FMO)

Not to be used for construction purposes unless approved.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-9
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 035
Layout and Technical Data

Dimensions in Inches (mm)


22
1 Minimum length of anchor bolt
3.50 3.50 2.00 inches (50.8 mm) 0.36 inches
2.20
(55.9)
(88.9) (88.9)
Removable 2
(9.1 mm)16 recommended. 23
Recommended maximum conduit height
Top Cover
3.22 above floor line 3.50 inches (88.9 mm).
(81.79) 3 Maximum conduit space with channel sills
17.50 x 14.11 (444.5 x 358.4) in
24
Top Conduit 21.00
Space 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep structure.
(533.4)
7.50 x 9.73 inches (190.5 x 247.1 mm) in
5.41
(137.4)
16.00-inch (406.4 mm) deep structure. 25
4 For multiple structure assemblies. Either one
2.20 4.81 or both of these members are removed to
Front Vertical
(55.9)
Wireway Door
(122.2) provide maximum unrestricted conduit
space at bottom. Not to be removed
26
17.50
1.25 (444.5) 1.25 7.31 for Seismic.
(31.8) (31.8) (185.7) 5 This conduit space not recommended when
20.00
(508.0) Rear
Wire Tie
Brackets neutral bus required. Otherwise available. 27
6 Channel sills supplied only when specified.
Vertical
Wireway 7.31 For seismic loads, channel sills if required
1.25 17.50 1.25 (185.7)
(31.8) (444.50) (31.8) must be embedded so top of channel sill 28
 Vertical
is still at floor level.
Removable Bottom 4.81 Wireway
5.41 Frame Members  (122.2) See Side View B Page 29.2-6 for
(137.4)
5.78
18.35
(466.1) vertical dimensions.
29
(146.81)
Bottom Conduit Space 
5.41
(137.4) 30
1.32
(33.5)
2.00
.53 Dia.

16.00
(406.4)
(50.8) 31
.53 Dia.

Figure 29.2-7. 20.00 Inches (508.0 mm) Wide, 21.00 Inches (533.4 mm) Deep 32
Front- and Rear-Mounted

33
Removable
Top Cover
12.12
Horizontal Bus
Location 
34
Ground Bus (307.9)
Top Conduit Location 3.12
Space 20.38 (79.25)
5.41
(517.7)
or 16.00
2.25
4.62
(117.35)
35
(137.4) (406.4)
(57.15) 4.62
(117.35)

7.50 Horizontal Removable Bus 36


2.20 1.25 1.25 Barrier
(190.5) (31.8) Wireway
(55.9) (31.8) 7.16 inches
(181.9 mm) deep
10.00
(254.0) Flat Cover 37
Supplied on
7.50 Rear of Front
(190.5) Mounted Only
1.25
(31.8)
1.25
(31.8)
Structure 38
 Removable Bottom
5.41 Frame Members 
(137.4)
18.35 (466.1)
39
5.78
(146.81) or 13.97 (354.8)

5.41
(137.4)
Bottom Conduit
Space  40
5.00
1.58 (127.0)
(40.1) Floor Line
.70

.53 Dia. 5.00
(17.8) 9.73 (247.14)
or 14.11 (358.4) 3.00 41
(2)
(127.0) 1.00 (76.2)
(25.4) 20.11 (510.8)
or 15.73 (399.5)
10.50
(266.7)
Location of Neutral Bus
When Specified
42
Figure 29.2-8. 10.00 Inches (254.0 mm) Wide, 16.00 or 21.00 Inches (406.4 or 533.4 mm) Deep
Transition Structure
43

Not to be used for construction purposes unless approved.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-10 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 036
Layout and Technical Data

22 Right-Hand 0.50 1.25


18.60
(472.5)
Drawing (12.7) (31.8)
20.00 20.00 20.00
23 (508.0) (508.0) (508.0)
18.00
18.38 (457.2)
(466.9)
24 19.22 Corner 16.00
(406.4)
(488.2) Enclosure

25 1.25
1.25
(31.8)
16.00
(406.4) Top & Bottom (31.8)
10.00
26 20.00
(508.0)
Conduit / Wire Space (254.0)

27 4.78
5.40
(137.2)
(121.4)
20.00 (Ref)
28 (508.0) 2.00 2.00
Front (50.8) (50.8)

29 0.00
1.25 19.22
5.65
(143.6) (31.8) (488.2)
20.00 Corner 0.00
16.00 18.60
30 (508.0) Enclosure
(406.4) 2.00 4.62 (472.5)
(50.8) (117.4)

31 19.22
(488.2)
20.00
(508.0)
4.00
(101.6)
11.48
(291.6)
(Ref) Horizontal Bus Location
Right-Hand Drawing
32
Figure 29.2-9. 16.00-Inch (406.4 mm) DeepFront-Mounted Corner Structure (inside corner shown; consult factory for outside corner option)

33 0.50 1.25 22.97


(12.7) (31.8) (538.4)
Right-Hand 24.38 20.00
34 Drawing (616.7) (508.0)
24.38
(616.7)
22.76 22.38
(578.1) 3.49 (568.5)
35 23.60 Corner
Enclosure
21.00 (88.7)
(599.4) (533.4)

36
21.00
(533.4)
20.00 Top & Bottom
37 (508.0) Conduit / Wire Space
1.25 12.19
(31.8) (309.6)
38
1.25
(31.8)
20.00 5.40
39 (508.0) (137.2)
Front
4.78
40 (121.4)
(Ref)
24.38 2.00 2.00
Corner 21.00 (50.8)
(50.8)
41 (616.7) Enclosure (533.4) 0.00

2.00 5.65 1.25 23.60


23.60 20.00
42 (599.4) (508.0) (50.8) (143.5) (31.8) (599.4)
4.62 22.97
0.00
Right-Hand (117.4) (583.4)
43 Drawing 4.00
(101.6)
11.48
(291.6)
(Ref) Horizontal Bus Location

Figure 29.2-10. 21.00-Inch (533.4 mm) DeepFront- and Rear-Mounted Corner Structure

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-11
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 037
Layout and Technical Data

SECTION A-A Minimum Rated Vertical Bus


22
CL Gasketed Side Sheet Supplied on Front
23.50 Mounted Only Structures
3.50 3.50 0.18
(88.9) (88.9) (4.6) (599.4) 0.18 (4.6) 23
Top
Conduit Vertical
Space 2.87 (72.9) Wireway
Wire Tie 24
7.97 (204.2) 20.30 Brackets
(515.6)

5.00 (127.0) 28.85 7.31 (185.7) 25


(732.8)
4.25 (108.0)
1.88
(47.8) 4.81 (122.2) 26
4.25 1.75 (44.5)
(108.0) 9.80 28.85 (732.8)
(248.9) 11.42 Horizontal Bus Location
Upper Horizontal (290.1) Vertical Bus Location
27
Wireway Door 2.25
25.75 4.82
(654.1) (57.2) (122.4) 4.62 (117.3)
28
A 2.38
(60.5) 2.12
(53.8)
29


0.75
(19.1)
30
95.25 24.85
(2419.4) Vertical (631.2)
Wireway
Channel Sills
4 x 1.56 (101.6 x 39.6)
31
90.00 Supplied Only When Specified
(2286.0) 94.62
(2403.3) Detail 2
32

1.25
Lower (31.8)
Horizontal Max. 33
Wireway A 01 02 03 A 5.00
Door
(127.0)
2.25 34
2.25 (57.2)
(57.2) B 1.56
Floor (39.6) 23.35
Line 0.75
(19.1)
(593.1) 35
1.75 (44.5) 15.69 (398.5) 19.35 (491.5) 4.00 24.85
1.75 4.00 (631.2)
4.31 (109.5) (44.5) (101.6) 24.85 (631.2) (101.6)
4.25 (108.0)
1.88 (47.8)
20 (508.0) 14.04
(356.6)
Location of Neutral Detail 1 36
Bus When Specified
Bottom
Conduit
Space 5.00 (127.0)
0.75 (19.1)
37
24.85
5.78 (146.8) 23.35
15.78 (631.2) (593.1)
5.00 (127.0)
(400.8) 38
0.75 (19.1)
3.78 (96.0)

3.00
17.50
(444.5) 3.00
39
(76.2) (76.2) 3.75 16.00
(406.4) 3.75
23.50 (596.9) (95.3) (95.3)
40
Figure 29.2-11. Freedom and Freedom FlashGard Motor Control Center Outline and Floor Plan NEMA 3R 28.85-Inch (732.8 mm) Deep Structure
Dimensions in Inches (mm)
1 Minimum length of anchor bolt 2.00 inches (50.8 mm). 38.00 (9.7 mm)16 recommended.
41
2 Recommended maximum conduit height above floor line 3.50 inches (88.9 mm).
3
4
Maximum conduit space with channel sills 15.78 x 16.6 inches (400.8 x 421.6 mm).
Master terminal block assembly furnished for type C wiring only. When location not specified MTB supplied at the bottom.
42
5 Recommended standard anchor bolting for Detail 1. When channel sills are used, see Detail 2.
6 This conduit space is not recommended when neutral bus is required. Otherwise available.
7 Top rear conduit space is not recommended for conduit entry in front mounted only structure.
43
8 Standard structure arrangement (in front) without master terminal block, A and B9.00 inches (228.6 mm). With master terminal block at bottom,
A and B9.00 inches (228.6 mm). With master terminal block at top: A15.00 inches (381.0 mm), B3.00 inches (76.2 mm).

Note: Rear horizontal bus barrier is not supplied with front-mounted only structure.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-12 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 038
Layout and Technical Data

22 14.17 7.31 Vertical Wireway 1 2.12 1


(359.9) (185.7) (53.8)
2.50 22.18 3.00
Wire Tie 1.75 (563.4) (76.2)
(63.5)
23 Brackets (44.5)

4.81 (122.2) 2.00 3.50


(88.9)
24 W
2.00
(50.8)
W-9.00 (50.8) W-6.00
(228.6) 2.00 A (152.4)
25 (50.8) 48.82 (1240.0)
Aisle 2.00 3.50
(50.8) (88.9)
26 2.50
9.63 1.75 5.41
(244.6) 2 (44.5) (137.4) 3.00
(63.5)
Door Opening 1 2.12 2.20 (76.2)
27 36.00 (914.4) W x 90.00 (2288.0) H (53.8) 1.88
(47.8)
20.30 (55.9)
2.25 (515.6)
71.00 (1803.4) 2.25
(57.2) 71.00
(57.2)
(1803.4)
28 75.50 (1917.7)

11.68 10.50
29 (296.7) (266.7) Vertical Bus Location
10.06 12.12 2.00
(255.5) Horizontal Bus Location (50.8)
(307.8) 0.38 0.38 0.38
W
30 4.00 3.00 20.10 Ground Bus Location
15 Ref. (9.7) (9.7) (9.7)
(101.6) (76.2) (510.5)

31
3.12 (79.3)
1
2.25
32 2 (57.2) Ground Bus
4.62
(117.3) 3 3
33 4.62
(117.3)
4

34 102.40
90.00 (2601.0)
(2286.0)
35
4 Vertical
36 Bus
3
5.00 1 2 3
(127.0)
37 MTB Top
16.44 (417.6) 4.00
B (101.6)
MTB Bottom
22.44 (570.0)
38
4.00 11.68 10.50 Location of Neutral Bus W
(296.7) (266.7)
39 (101.6) When Specified 1.81 (46.0) Isolation Barrier (Standard)
See 71.00 15.58 (395.7) Labyrinth Barrier
Detail A (1803.4) When Specified Insulated/Isolated
40 Top Conduit Space

Figure 29.2-12. Freedom and Freedom FlashGard NEMA 3R Walk-In Aisle StructuresDimensions in Inches (mm)
41 1 All doors open minimum of 105.
2 Rear vertical bus barrier not supplied with front-mounted only structure.
3 Standard structure arrangement (in front) without master terminal block, A and B9.00 inches (228.6 mm). With master terminal block at bottom,
42 A and B9.00 inches (228.6 mm). With master terminal block at top: A15.00 inches (381.0 mm), B3.00 inches (76.2 mm).
4 Master terminal block assembly furnished for type C wiring only. When location is not specified MTB is supplied at the bottom.

Note: Minimum rated vertical bus supplied as standard. Rear conduit space not recommended for conduit entry in front mounted only
43 structure. Top rear conduit space not recommended for conduit entry in front mounted only structure.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-13
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 039
Layout and Technical Data

22

3.00 W 3.00 23
(76.2) (76.2)
W-6.00
(152.4) 24
4.00
(101.6)
22.18
(563.4)
4.79
(121.7) 3/8-16 Stud and
25
5.78 Lockwasher
15.98 (146.8)
(406.0) 26
5.41
(137.4) 1.25
71.00 (31.8)
(1803.4) 27
2.20
(55.9)
2.25 71.00
28
(57.2) (1803.4)
75.50
(1917.7) 29
Bottom Conduit Space Tie DownDetail A
30
Figure 29.2-13. Freedom and Freedom FlashGard NEMA 3R Walk-In Aisle StructuresDimensions in Inches (mm)
1
2
Minimum length of anchor bolt above grade 1.25 (31.75) (0.38-16 grade 5 torqued at 31 lb ft (43.4 Nm).
Recommended maximum conduit height above floor line 5.50 inches (139.7 mm).
31
3 Maximum conduit space B.
4 This conduit space not recommended when a neutral bus is required. The space is otherwise available.
32
Table 29.2-11. Dimensions in Inches (mm) Metering and Bus Protection
Outdoor Structure
Width (W)
Indoor Structure
Width (A)
Maximum Conduit
Space (B)
Table 29.2-12. Incoming Line Metering and Bus Protection 5 33
Type Description Unit Space
23.50 (596.9) 20.00 (508.0) 17.50 x 15.98 (444.5 x 405.9) Inches (mm) 6
27.50 (698.5) 24.00 (609.6) 21.50 x 15.98 (546.1 x 405.9)
Switchboard Ammeter 12.00 (304.8)
34
31.50 (800.1) 28.00 (711.2) 25.50 x 15.98 (647.7 x 405.9)
meters 7 Ammeter with switch or 2X
35.50 (901.7) 32.00 (812.8) 29.50 x 15.98 (749.3 x 405.9)
1% accuracy Voltmeter
Voltmeter with switch 35
AM/VM
AM/VM with switches
Instrument 600/800A CT Consult
36
Transformers 1000A CT Eaton
2000A CT
2500A CT 37
480/120 PT 6.00 (152.4)
or 1X
Signal Current (add CT) single-phase 6.00 (152.4) 38
transducers Voltage (add PT) or 1X
Watt (add CT and PT) single-phase
Voltage Protection 39
SPD (see Table 29.2-20 on Page 29.2-15) 18.00 (457.2)
Ground detection lightsthree-phase underground systems or 3X 8
System voltage monitor 6.00 (152.4) 40
Lightning arrester and surge capacitor or 1X
Ground Fault Sensing C-HRG Safe Ground High Resistance Ground System
Current Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep, 72.00 (1828.8)
41
Voltage 20.00-inch (508.0 mm) wide structure or 12X
without a vertical wireway.
5 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
42
FlashGard MCCs.
6 Two electronic meters will fit in a single 12.00-inch (304.8 mm) (2X) unit.
7 Ammeters require two CTs for three-phase/three-wire systems, and 43
three CTs for three-phase/four-wire systems. Voltmeters require two
PTs for three-phase/three-wire systems, and three PTs for three-phase/
four-wire systems.
8 Without disconnect 12.00 inches (304.8 mm) or 2X.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-14 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 040
Layout and Technical Data

Harmonic Correction Table 29.2-16. Lighting Panelboard Circuit Breakers 6


22 Table 29.2-13. Clean Control Center 1 Eatons circuit breakers can be either plug-in or bolt-on,
single-, two- or three-pole through 240 V. 600 V maximum
Eatons Clean Control Center is an integrated power correction single-, two- or three-pole circuit breakers are bolt-on.
23 system that provides harmonic correction directly on the
Poles Maximum Plug-in Bolt-on Ampere
MCC horizontal bus. The harmonic correction unit senses the
Voltage Interrupting
load current and dynamically injects into the horizontal bus a Capacity
24 synthesized waveform that cancels harmonic content from
nonlinear loads such as AC drives. The result is a clean 1/2/3 240 HQP BAB 10,000
waveform. Clean Control Centers are UL 845 listed. 1/2/3 240 QPHW QBHW 22,000
1/2/3 600 EHD 14,000
25 Harmonic Input Disconnect Standard Standard 1/2/3 600 HFD 65,000
Current Voltage Type Unit Space 2 Unit 6
(Amperes) Inches (mm) Space (X) This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
FlashGard MCCs.
26 50 A active Up to Molded- 72.00 H x 20.00 W 12X
harmonic filter 3 480V case switch (1828.8 H x 508.0 W) Automatic Transfer Switches
100 A active Up to Molded- 72.00 H x 20.00 W 12X
27 harmonic filter 3 480V case switch (1828.8 H x 508.0 W)
Table 29.2-17. Automatic Transfer SwitchesDimensions in
Inches (mm) 7
1 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
FlashGard MCCs. Ampere Switch Interrupting Unit Unit
28 2 Clean Control Center model includes 24.00-inch (609.6 mm) wide MCE Rating Type 8 Rating (kA) Width Space
structure, current transformers and door-mounted digital interface panel.
100 9 Eaton MTVX, NTVS 65 20.00 (508.0) 9 36.00 (914.4)
3 Multiple units can be applied in parallel for additional 150 9 Eaton MTVX, NTVS 65 or 6X
29 harmonic correction.
100 Eaton ATVI 65 48.00 (1219.2)
150 Eaton ATVI 65 or 8X
Panelboards
30 Table 29.2-14. Lighting Panelboards
225
300
Eaton ATVI
Eaton ATVI
65
65
72.00 (1828.8)
or 12X
120/240 V or 120/208 V Lighting Panelboards TypePL1A 4 400 Eaton ATVI 65
Fixed mounted, main lug only panelboards can be either 600 Eaton ATVI 50 24.00 (609.6) 9 72.00 (1828.8)
31 120/240 V, single-phase, three-wire; 208Y / 120 V, three- 800 Eaton ATVI 50 or 12X
phase, four-wire. 1000 Eaton ATVI 50
1000 Eaton ATVISP 100 44.00 (1117.6) j 72.00 (1828.8)
32 Number Chassis Rating
of (Amperes)
Unit Space
Inches (mm)
1200 Eaton ATVISP 100 or 12X
1600 Eaton ATVISP 100
Circuits Single- Three- Single-Phase Three-Phase 2000 Eaton ATVISP 100
33 Phase Phase
Three-Wire Four-Wire
Three-Wire Four-Wire
100 ASCO Type 7000 65 20.00 (508.0) j 72.00 (1828.8)
150 ASCO Type 7000 65 or 12X
18 225 100 24.00 (609.6) or 4X 24.00 (609.6) or 4X 260 ASCO Type 7000 65 28.00 (711.2) j
34 30
42
225
225
100
225
30.00 (762.0) or 5X 30.00 (762.0) or 5X
36.00 (914.4) or 6X 36.00 (914.4) or 6X
400 ASCO Type 7000 35
600 ASCO Type 7000 35 36.00 (914.4) j
4 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom 800 ASCO Type 7000 50
35 FlashGard MCCs.
1000 ASCO Type 7000 50 40.00 (1016.0) j
Note: For MCB, back-feed panelboard branch circuit breaker, 1200 ASCO Type 7000 100
or select separate feeder unit. 7 This table is common for both Freedom and Freedom FlashGard MCCs;
36 Note: Bolt-on single-, two-, three-pole breakers only. not available in Freedom Arc.
8 ATVI designs include ATC controller door mounted microprocessor-
Table 29.2-15. 277/480 V or 480/600 V Lighting Panelboards Type PRL3A 5 based monitoring device for use in open transition transfer switches
37 Fixed mounted, main lug only panelboards can be either where rapid, reliable restoration of power in outage situations is essen-
tial. The ATC controller is a microprocessor-based logic controller to be
480 or 600 V, three-phase, three-wire or 480Y / 277 V, three- used with Eaton transfer switches. This device provides the operator
phase, four-wire. Mounted in bottom portion of structure. with an at-a-glance overview of switch status and parameters, as well
38 Number Chassis Unit Space Inches (mm) as key diagnostic data. Real-time values for volts and frequency can be
of Circuits Rating Three-Phase Three-Phase viewed via the front panel LED display, along with an indication of the
(Amperes) Three-Wire Four-Wire power source currently in use. The ATC controller continuously moni-
39 14 100 36.00 (914.4) or 6X
tors either single-phase or three-phase voltages for Source 1, Source 2
and the Load. Depending on the application, the user can customize
18 250 36.00 (914.4) or 6X the ATC controller to meet specific application need.
24 100 36.00 (914.4) or 6X 9 Manually operated switch: MTVX = Single handle manual operation.
40 26 250 48.00 (1219.2) or 8X NTVS = Electrically operated non-automatic.
32 100 48.00 (1219.2) or 8X j Requires 42.00-inch (1066.8 mm) deep structure.
36 250 48.00 (1219.2) or 8X

41 42
42
100
250
48.00 (1219.2) or 8X
60.00 (1524.0) or 10X
60.00 (1524.0) or 10X
60.00 (1524.0) or 10X
12 400/600 36.00 (914.4) or 6X
14 400/600 48.00 (1219.2) or 8X
42 30 400/600 48.00 (1219.2) or 8X 60.00 (1524.0) or 10X
42 400/600 60.00 (1524.0) or 10X 72.00 (1828.8) or 12X
5 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
43 FlashGard MCCs.
Note: For MCB, back-feed panelboard branch circuit breaker,
or select separate feeder unit.
Note: Either plug-in or bolt-on single-, two-, three-pole breakers only.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-15
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 041
Layout and Technical Data

Dry-Type Transformers Surge Protective Devices


Table 29.2-18. Dry-Type Distribution Transformers 1 Table 29.2-20. SPD (Surge Protective Device) with Circuit Breaker
22
Transformer 1.02.0 kVA will include a circuit breaker Disconnect 4
and fuses in a standard 2X unit Includes SuperVisor Monitoring Display with power quality 23
Transformers 3.0 kVA and above have taps and meter for volts, sag, swell, outage, transient counter, Form C
electrostatic shields as standard contact, alarm enable and disable, and circuit breaker disconnect.
Transformers 3.0 kVA and above will include the primary and Description Unit Space 5 24
secondary circuit breakers housed behind a single door Inches X
(mm) Space
kVA
Rating
Unit
Space
Primary Breaker
(Included in Space Factor)
Secondary Breaker 2
(Included in Surge Current Per Phase 25
230 V 480 V Space Factor) 100 kA SPD-100 18.00 (457.2) 3X
120 kA SPD-120 (recommended branch unit) 18.00 (457.2) 3X
Single-Phase 160 kA SPD-160 18.00 (457.2) 3X 26
0.5 2X 15 15 200 kA SPD-200 18.00 (457.2) 3X
0.75 2X 15 15 250 kA SPD-250 (recommended service entrance) 18.00 (457.2) 3X
1 2X 15 15 300 kA SPD-300
400 kA SPD-400
18.00 (457.2)
18.00 (457.2)
3X
3X
27
1.5 2X 15 15
2 2X 15 15 4 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
3 4X 15 15 20
5
FlashGard MCCs. 28
5 4X 15 15 30 Also available in 12.00-inch (304.8 mm) unit (2X)
7.5 4X 20 20 40 without circuit breaker disconnect.
10 4X 25 30 60 Note: Specify three-phase delta or three-phase wye.
15 5X 40 40 90
29
20 5X 50 60 125 Option Groups for AC Combination Starters, AFDs
25 5X 60 70 150
30 6X 70 80 175
Note: Option groups are common to both Freedom and 30
Freedom FlashGard MCCs.
45 7X 100 125 250
Three-Phase Option Group A 31
9 5X 15 15 40
Table 29.2-21. Wiring Class
15 5X 20 25 60
25 6X 40 40 90 Description
30 6X 40 50 125
32
NEMA Class IA 6
45 6X 60 70 175 NEMA Class IC
1 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
FlashGard MCCs.
NEMA Class IIB 33
NEMA Class IIC
2 Transformers feeding an MCC mounted panelboard require a NEMA Class IS (includes 1B wiring and 2B schematics)
secondary breaker or main breaker in panelboard. 6 Control terminal blocks and device panels not included with 34
NEMA 1A wiring.
Power Factor Correction Capacitors
Table 29.2-19. Power Factor Correction Capacitors 3 Table 29.2-22. 100 kA Circuit Breaker Starter Interrupting Capacity 35
PF capacitors are electrolytic type and are optionally Starter Type Voltage
available with external line fuses and blown fuse indicators.
Starters with HMCPs 480
Capacitors sizes must be specified by the customer. Starters with thermal-magnetic circuit breakers 480 36
Starters with HMCPs 600 7
Caution: Capacitors on the main bus of the MCC may affect
Starters with thermal-magnetic circuit breakers 600 7
solid-state equipment. Please consult factory.
7 Current limiter attachments are used. Add 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) to all
37
kVAR 208 V Unit Space 240 V Unit Space 600 V Unit Space
size 3 and 4 starters.
Rating Inches X Inches X Inches X
(mm) Space (mm) Space (mm) Space Table 29.2-23. Control Circuit TransformersTypical Sizing 8 38
2 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X Starter Size
3 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X
4 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 1, 2 (100 VA)includes extra 50 VA 39
5 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 3, 4 (150 VA)includes extra 50 VA
7.5 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 5, 6 (250 VA)includes extra 50 VA
10 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X Extra 50 VA, size 1, 2 40
15 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X Extra 100 VA, size 3, 4
20 24.00 (609.6) 4X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X Extra 150 VA, size 5, 6
22.5
25
24.00 (609.6)

4X

12.00 (304.8) 2X
24.00 (609.6) 4X
12.00 (304.8)
12.00 (304.8)
2X
2X
8 Refer to Table 29.2-6 for actual ratings. 41
Note: Price includes one secondary and two primary fuses.
30 24.00 (609.6) 4X 12.00 (304.8) 2X
40 12.00 (304.8) 2X
50 24.00 (609.6) 4X
42
60 24.00 (609.6) 4X
75 24.00 (609.6) 4X
90 24.00 (609.6) 4X 43
100 36.00 (914.4) 6X
120 36.00 (914.4) 6X
3 This table is common for Freedom, Freedom Arc and Freedom
FlashGard MCCs.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-16 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 042
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.2-24. Control Circuit Fusing Table 29.2-30. Miscellaneous Options


22 Description Description

Control fuse and auxiliary switch Mini ammeter and CT 4


23 Control fuse
Blown fuse indicator
Mini voltmeter
Mini elapsed time meter
Panel elapsed time meter 5
Note: Required in accordance with NEC for all starter units with
24 control wiring external to the MCC. See NEC, General for exceptions.
Operations counter
Wiring diagram on door
Coil surge suppressor
Table 29.2-25. Motor Starter Auxiliary Contacts CT for remote metering (requires additional 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space)
25 Description Heater packs installed
Device labels
1NO or 1NC (sizes 14) Maximum of eight on each contactor 1 Blank device panels
26 1NO or 1NC (sizes 56) Maximum of four on each contactor 4 May add 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) to unit size. Consult factory.
1 Maximum of four per contactor on multi-contactor starters and 5 May add 6.00 inches (152.4 mm). Consult factory.
6.00-inch (152.4 mm) units.
27 Table 29.2-31. Vacuum Contactors in Lieu of Air Break
Table 29.2-26. Interlock for Switch or Breaker Operator
Starter Type
Description
28 1NO1NC
FVNR Available sizes 46
FVR, 2S2W, PW
2NO2NC RVAT, 2S1W, YD-Open
29 Note: For use when control circuit is fed from an external source.
YD-Closed

Table 29.2-32. Ground Fault ProtectionInstantaneous or Adjustable


Table 29.2-27. Internal Circuit Breaker Options
30 Description
Description

D64 relay (with zero sequence CT) Requires additional


Alarm contact 6.00-inch (152.4 mm)
31 Auxiliary 1NO1NC space
Auxiliary 2NO2NC
120 V shunt trip Note: Option groups are common to both Freedom and
50 C (thermal-magnetic) Freedom FlashGard MCCs.
32
Table 29.2-28. Terminal Blocks Table 29.2-33. Power FusesR, J Type
Ampere Rating
33 Description

7 Terminal Side mounted 2 30 Optional


(Will accept stripped wire or ring/spade 60 Optional
34 wire lug12 AWG bare/14 AWG ring/spade) 100 Optional

Front railpressure connector Additional 6.00-inch (152.4 200 Optional


Front railpull apart mm) space required for 400 Optional
35 Front railutility/accepts ring wire lug. Freedom starters sizes 14 600 Optional
2 Use Burndy YAEV10-L36 for #10 AWG compression termination.
Table 29.2-34. Power Factor Capacitor Options
36 Table 29.2-29. Control Wire Options Description

Description Blown power fuse indicator (set of threeone per phase)

37 #16 AWG (standard)


Table 29.2-35. Current Limiter Attachment for HMCP
#14 AWG
Wire markers Description
38 Spade wire terminals
Ring wire terminals 3 Size 12
Wiring to common CPT Size 3 Requires additional 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space
Size 4 Requires additional 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space
39 SIS power wiresubstitution
SIS control wiresubstitution
Starter Class 2 interwiring/per wire
3
40 Freedom Starter control terminals only available with spade
wire terminals.

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.2-17
January 2016 Standard Structures and Structure Options
Sheet 29 043
Layout and Technical Data

Option Group B Table 29.2-40. Extra Bi-Metallic Overload RelayType C306


Devices may require extra unit space. Description 22
Table 29.2-36. Timing Relays Size 132A overload relay
Type of Relay Mounting
Size 275A overload relay
Size 3100A overload relay
23
Size 4144A overload relay
Solid-state timer Panel
PneumaticAGASTAT Panel on or off delay
Option Group D 24
24-hour motor timer Panel
7-day timer Panel Devices may require extra unit space.
Repeat cycle timer Door or panel
Table 29.2-41. Solid-State Overload Relays 25
Table 29.2-37. Control Relays Description
Number of Poles Type
C440 solid-state overload with ground fault protection 4 26
Two-pole General purpose Type D7 socket relay C441 Motor Insight
Four-pole N300 fixed contacts MP-3000 motor protector

Two-pole Type AR machine tool relays


MP-3000 RTD module 27
4 Size 4 starters require an additional 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) (1X) space
Four-pole N600 convertible contacts
Six-pole when used with solid-state overloads.
Eight-pole
Note: Option groups are common to Freedom, Freedom Arc and 28
Ten-pole
Freedom FlashGard MCCs.
Two-pole Type MD26 relays
Three-pole
Four-pole
N600 convertible contacts
Option Group E 29
Six-pole 1 Table 29.2-42. Oiltight Pushbuttons, Lights, Selector Switches
Eight-pole 1
1 The six- and eight-pole units can be provided with four additional
Device Device Type 30
non-convertible NO contacts. Pushbuttons 10250T 56
1 unit
Table 29.2-38. Alternators 2 unit 31
3 unit
Description
Selector switches
Two-circuit alternator Panel (additional 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space 2 position 32
Three-circuit alternator required on size 1s and size 2s) 3 position
4 position
Key operated adder
Option Group C
Pilot lights
33
Devices may require extra unit space.
Standard transformer 6V bulb
Table 29.2-39. Monitoring Relays Standard transformer LED bulb
Push to test transformer 6V bulb 34
Type of Relay Push to test LED bulb

D60LA current sensing Additional Pushbuttons E30 56


voltage Price includes 1 PT 6.00-inch 1 unit 35
transducer (152.4 mm) 2 unit
space required 3 unit
AC current 05 thru 0100A
sensors 050 thru 0300A Selector switches 36
with CTs 2 0300 thru 0600A 2 position
3 position
AC current transducer, 420 mA, All Ratings 4 position
self-powered with CTs 3 Key operated adder 37
Phase monitoring relaythree-phase Pilot lights
Watt transducer, 420 mA, self-powered CTs 3 Standard transformer 6V bulb
2 Loop-powered devicesrequires 24 Vdc power source, which is Standard transformer LED bulb 38
typically provided in the PLC. Push to test Transformer 6V bulb
3 Does not require separate 24 Vdc power source. Suitable for powering Push to test LED bulb
analog meters. 5 Maximum two devices per starter in dual units. 39
6 Maximum of six devices without increasing compartment space.

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.2-18 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Standard Structures and Structure Options January 2016
Sheet 29 044
Layout and Technical Data

Option Group F
22
Options for 6.00-Inch (152.4 mm) Starter Units
Control terminal blocks are 300 V rated and are limited
23 to 12 points maximum
Standard VA control transformer only

24 Table 29.2-43. Oiltight Pushbuttons, Lights, Selector Switches


Device Device Type

25 Pushbuttons
1 unit
E22 1

2 unit
3 unit
26 Selector switches
2 position
3 position
27 4 position
Key operated adder
Pilot lights
28 Standard transformer 6V bulb
Standard transformer LED bulb
Push to test transformer 6V bulb
Push to test LED bulb
29 1 On 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) starter units, pilot devices are limited to
three E22 devices.

30 Option Group G
Table 29.2-44. Remote Racking System
31 Description

Wired remote racking system for FlashGard MCC units

32 Table 29.2-45. FlashGard Locking Accessory


Description

33 Locking accessory for FlashGard MCC

Option Group I
34
Optional Safety Accessories
Table 29.2-46. Automatic Insulation Tester
35 Description

Automatic insulation tester


36 Automatic insulation tester with megohm meter (mounted in unit door)

Table 29.2-47. Voltage Presence Indicator (VoltageVision)


37 Description

Voltage presence indicator (mounted on unit door)


38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.3-1
January 2016 Freedom
Sheet 29 045
General Description

Freedom Quick Reference Layout Guide Index


22
Device Space Requirements Table Page
Short-Circuit Ratings for Motor Control (480 V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-1 29.3-2
Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors 23
or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-2 29.3-2
Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-3 29.3-5 24
Option Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-4 29.3-5
Control Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-5 29.3-5
FLA Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-6 29.3-5
25
Combination Starters with Fusible Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-7 29.3-6
Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty RatingsFusible. . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-8 29.3-8 26
Control Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-9 29.3-8
Option Sizing for Isolating Contractor and Bypass Starter . . . . . 29.3-10 29.3-8 27
FLA Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-11 29.3-8
SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-12 29.3-9 28
Adjustable Frequency Drives Passive Filters Addition. . . . . . . . . 29.3-13 29.3-10
SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives in NEMA 3R MCCs . . . . 29.3-14 29.3-10
Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-15 29.3-10
29
CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives, Thermal-Magnetic
Freedom Motor Control Center and Motor Circuit Protector (MCP) Disconnect . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-16 29.3-11 30
CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives,
General Description Fusible Switch Disconnect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-17 29.3-11
31
Main Incoming Line and Feeder Circuit Breakers
Eatons Freedom MCC has been in Molded-Case Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-18 29.3-12
production since 1994, employing
the Freedom NEMA contactor in Main Circuit BreakersMagnum DS Air Circuit Breakers 32
combination with multiple motor Manually or Electrically OperatedFixed Mounted . . . . . . . . . 29.3-19 29.3-12
overload styles and either a fused Main Circuit BreakersMagnum DS Air Circuit Breakers
switch or a molded-case circuit breaker Manually or Electrically OperatedDrawout Mounted. . . . . . . 29.3-20 29.3-13 33
disconnect. The Freedom meets all the Digitrip Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-21 29.3-13
above listed standards, ratings and
features. Main-Tie-Main Auto Throw-Over Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-22 29.3-13 34
Freedom Main Incoming Line and Feeder
Fusible Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.3-23 29.3-13
35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.3-2 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom January 2016
Sheet 29 046
Layout and Technical Data

22 Technical Data
Table 29.3-1. Short-Circuit Ratings for Motor Control (480 V)
Short-Circuit Combination Starter Solid-State Adjustable
23 Protective Device FV and RV (kA) Reduced Voltage (kA) Frequency Drives (kA)

HMCP motor circuit protector (standard rating) 65 65 65


24 HMCP motor circuit protector (optional rating) 100 100 100
MCCB molded-case circuit breaker (standard rating) 65 65 65
MCCB molded-case circuit breaker (optional rating) 100 100
Fusible switch 100 100 100
25
Table 29.3-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers
26 Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors.
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP/HMCPE MCCB Freedom
27 Size Frame 12 Frame 3 Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
Full Voltage Non-Reversing Type F206
28 125 E 6.00 (152.4) 4 1X 4
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 12.00 (304.8) 5 2X 5
18.00 (457.2) 3X
29 125 E 6.00 (152.4) 4 1X 4
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 12.00 (304.8) 5 2X 5
18.00 (457.2) 3X
30 125 E 12.00 (304.8) 4 2X 4
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 18.00 (457.2) 6 3X 6
24.00 (609.6) 4X
31 4 40 50 75 100 100 150
HFD/FDC
HJD/JDC
12.00 (304.8) 7
18.00 (457.2) 67
2X
3X 6
24.00 (609.6) 7 4X
32 5
50
75
60
100
100
150
125
200
150
200
250
400
HJD/JDC
HKD/KDC
36.00 (914.4) 6X

25 100 250 300 400 600 HLD/LDC h 42.00 (1066.8) 7X i


6h
33 150
200 300
350
400

1200 HND
60.00 (1524.0) 10X

7 300 600 600 1200 HND 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X


34 Full Voltage Reversing Type F216
125 E 18.00 (457.2) 6 3X 6
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X
35 125 E 18.00 (457.2) 6 3X 6
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X
3 25 30 50 50 50 125/150 HFD/FDC/E 24.00 (609.6) k 6X
36 4 40 50 75 100 100 150 HJD/JDC 30.00 (762.0) k 5X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC
37 125 100 250 300 400 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
6 150 200 300 400 1200 HND 72.00 (1828.8) h 12X h
1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE magnetic only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V.
38 Optional HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V.
2 E-Frame motor circuit protection available for size 13 starters only.
3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
39 4 Maximum of (three) pilot devices, (two) auxiliary contacts 100 VA CPT maximum. Standard lugs only.
5 12.00-inch (304.8 mm)/2X unit is standard.
6 18.00-inch (457.2 mm)/3X unit is standard.
40 7
h
Minimum 30.00-inch (762.0 mm) space needed with thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.
1200 A HMCP frame available in 11X 66.00-inch (1676.4 mm).
i For top entry, 8X space required.
41 j
k
Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
30.00-inch (762.0 mm) space needed for thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.3-3
January 2016 Freedom
Sheet 29 047
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.3-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers (Continued)
Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors. 22
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP MCCB Freedom
Size Frame 12 Frame 23
Unit Size 23
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
Two-Speed One Winding, Constant/Variable Torque Type F946 24
125 E
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X
125 E 25
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X
125 E
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HJD/JDC 36.00 (914.4) 45 6X 26
150 HFD/FDC
4 40 50 75 100 100 250 HJD/JDC 36.00 (914.4) 45 6X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 27
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 6 12X
Two-Speed Two Winding, Constant/Variable Torque Type F956
125 E 28
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X
125 E
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X 29
3 125 E
25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 4 5X
30 40 60 75 100 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 4 5X 30
4 40 50 75 100 250 HJD/JDC 30.00 (762.0) 4 5X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 6 12X 31
Reduced Voltage Autotransformer Type F606
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 36.00 (914.4) 6X
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
32
4 30 50 75 100 100 150 HJD/JDC 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 33
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
6 150 200 300 400 400 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) g 12X
7 300 600 600 1200 HND 72.00 (1828.8) g 12X 34
Reduced Voltage Part Winding Type F706
24.00 (609.6) h
1PW 10 10 15 15 15 150 HFD/FDC 4X
35
2PW 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) h 4X
3PW 40 50 75 75 75 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) h 5X
100 125 150 HFD/FDC 36
60 60 125 150 150 250 HJD/JDC
4PW 75 75 150 400 HKD/KDC 36.00 (914.4) h 6X
100 125 250 300 400 HKD/KDC 37
5PW 150 150 250 350 350 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) g 12X
1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE Magnetic Only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V.

2
Optional HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V. 38
E-Frame motor circuit protector available through size 3 starter only.
3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
4
5
Add 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space for low speed disconnect.
42.00-inch (1066.8 mm) space needed with Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker. 48.00-inch (1219.2 mm) space needed with thermal-magnetic
39
circuit breaker.
6 Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
g Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep, 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
40
h For starting speed disconnect, add 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space.

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.3-4 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom January 2016
Sheet 29 048
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.3-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers (Continued)
22 Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors.
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP MCCB Freedom
23 Size Frame 12 Frame 23
Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space

24 Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Open Transition 4 Type F806


2YD 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 5X
30 40 75 75 5 150 HFD/FDC
25 3YD 40 50 250 HJD/JDC 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
60 75 125 150 150 250 HJD/JDC
4YD 150 400 HKD/KDC 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
26 100 125 200 250 300 400 HKD/KDC
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 4 12X
Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Closed Transition 4 Type F896
27 2YD 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
3YD 40 50 250 HFD/FDC 54.00 (1371.6) 9X

28 4YD
60

75 125
150
150

150

250
400
HJD/JDC
HKD/KDC 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
100 125 200 250 300 400 HKD/KDC
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 4 12X
29 1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE magnetic only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V.
Optional HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V.
2 E-Frame motor circuit protector available through size 3 starter only.
30 3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
4 Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep, 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.3-5
January 2016 Freedom
Sheet 29 049
Layout and Technical Data

S811+ Solid-State Reduced Voltage Starter Motor Service Factor (SF) Effect on S811+ Starter Selection
Eatons S811+ solid-state reduced voltage starter uses SCRs A 1.0 service factor motor may draw up to 22
when starting and a low impedance run circuit during 1.00 x full load amperes
operation. The S811+ solid-state starter has five 24 Vdc A 1.15 service factor motor may draw up to
inputs and two relay outputs. S811+ soft start units include 1.15 x full load amperes (15% more current). 23
a disconnect, starter, 24 Vdc power supply and 100 VA CPT. This chart is based off of a 1.15 SF motor selection
S811+ starters are current rated devices. In some cases,
a larger S811+ SSRV starter must be supplied for 1.15 SF
24
motors. See the maximum horsepower chart below
Table 29.3-3. Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty Ratings 1 25
S811+ S811+ 208 V 230 V 380 V 460 V 575 V Inches X
Amperage Frame hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse (mm) Space
26
Standard Duty
37 65 10 50 70 30/60 10 50 70 30/60 15 50 70 30/60 20 50 70 30/60 30 50 80 30/60 18 (457.2) 3X
66
105
65
110
15 100
30 150
125 100
225 200
20 100
30 150
125 100 30
200 200 45
100
150
150 100 40 100
150 200 60 150
150 100 50 100
150 200 75 150
150 100 18 (457.2)
200 200 18 (457.2)
3X
3X
27
135 110 40 150 225 200 40 150 250 200 55 150 250 200 75 150 250 200 100 150 250 200 18 (457.2) 3X
180
240
200
200
50 250
60 250
400 400
400 400
60 250
75 250
350 400 75
450 400 110
250
400
350 400 125 250
500 400 150 400
400 400 150 250
500 400 200 250
350
450
400
400
36 (914.4)
36 (914.4)
6X
6X
28
304 200 75 400 600 400 100 400 600 600 132 400 600 600 200 400 600 600 250 400 600 600 36 (914.4) 6X
360 290 100 400 700 600 125 400 800 600 160 600 800 600 300 400 800 600 54 (1371.6) 9X
420 290 125 600 900 600 200 600 1000 800 300 600 1000 800 350 600 900 600 54 (1371.6) 9X 29
500 290 150 600 1000 800 250 600 1000 800 350 600 1000 800 450 600 1000 800 54 (1371.6) 9X
650 290 200 1200 1200 1200 200 1200 1200 800 315 1200 1200 1200 450 1200 1200 1200 600 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
720 290 250 1200 1200 1200 500 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X 30
850 290 300 1200 1200 1200 375 1200 1200 1200 600 1200 2000 1200 700 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
1000 290 350 2000 2000 1200 500 2000 2000 1200 700 2000 2000 1200 900 2000 2000 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
Severe Duty 31
22 65 5 70 40 5 70 35 7.5 60 35 10 60 35 15 70 40 18 (457.2) 3X
42 65 10 125 70 10 125 70 18.5 150 90 25 150 80 30 125 80 18 (457.2) 3X
65 110 15 200 110 20 200 125 22 150 100 40 150 125 50 200 125 18 (457.2) 3X 32
80 110 20 225 150 25 300 175 37 300 175 50 250 150 60 250 150 18 (457.2) 3X
115 200 30 300 225 30 350 200 55 300 250 75 300 225 100 300 250 36 (914.4) 6X
150 200 40 350 250 50 400 300 100 400 300 125 400 300 36 (914.4) 6X 33
192 200 50 400 350 60 500 350 90 500 400 125 500 400 150 400 350 36 (914.4) 6X
240 290 60 500 400 110 600 500 150 600 450 54 (1371.6) 9X
305 290 75 700 500 100 800 600 132 800 600 200 800 600 250 800 600 54 (1371.6) 9X 34
365 290 100 900 700 125 1000 800 160 900 700 250 1000 700 300 900 700 72 (1828.8) 12X
420 290 125 1000 800 200 1200 800 300 1200 800 350 1000 800 72 (1828.8) 12X
480 290 150 1200 800 220 1200 1000 350 1200 1000 450 1200 1000 72 (1828.8) 12X 35
525 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
600 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
1 Standard-duty ratings reflect the maximum starting duty that these units are designed to supply. 36
Table 29.3-4. Option SizingDimensions in Inches (mm) Table 29.3-6. FLA Ratings
S811+ Width
(mm)
Disconnect
Type
Starter
Size
Option Unit
Size 2
Structure
Width
Ramp Current %
of FLA
Ramp
Time
Starts
Per Hour
Similar to
Starting Method
37
Isolating Contactor Standard Duty
65 HMCP, MCCB 1, 2, 3 30.00 (762.0) 20.00 (508.0)
110 HMCP, MCCB 3, 4 36.00 (914.4) 20.00 (508.0)
300%
500%
30 seconds
10 seconds
3
3
Soft start
Full voltage
38
110 HMCP, MCCB 5 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0) 350% 20 seconds 3 Wye delta
200 HMCP, MCCB 5,6 72.00 (1828.8) 20.00 (508.0) 480% 20 seconds 2 80% RVAT
290 HMCP, MCCB 6 72.00 (1828.8) 32.00 (812.8) 390% 20 seconds 3 65% RVAT 39
290 HMCP, MCCB 7 72.00 (1828.8) 48.00 (1219.2) 300% 20 seconds 4 50% RVAT
Bypass Starter Severe Duty
65 HMCP, MCCB 1, 2, 3 30.00 (762.0) 20.00 (508.0) 450% 30 seconds 4 Soft start 40
110 HMCP, MCCB 3, 4 36.00 (914.4) 20.00 (508.0) 500% 10 seconds 10 Full voltage
110 HMCP, MCCB 5 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0) 350% 65 seconds 3 Wye delta
200
290
HMCP, MCCB
HMCP, MCCB
5, 6
6
72.00 (1828.8)
72.00 (1828.8)
24.00 (609.6)
32.00 (812.8) 480% 25 seconds 4 80% RVAT 41
290 HMCP, MCCB 7 72.00 (1828.8) 48.00 (1219.2) 390% 40 seconds 4 65% RVAT
300% 60 seconds 4 50% RVAT
2 Option fits in standard unit space.
42
Table 29.3-5. Control Options
Extra 50 VA Control Power Transformer 34
24 Vdc Control 3 43
Line or Load MOV Protection 3
Pump Control Option 3
3 Option fits in standard unit space.
4 Option adds 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) (1X) to 37 and 66 A units.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.3-6 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom January 2016
Sheet 29 050
Layout and Technical Data

All of Eatons combination starters are available with Class R


22 or J fuse clips for all voltages. If 100 kA SCR is required at
575 V and 600 V, fuses must be used where current limiting
options are not available in combination with breakers.
23 When selecting fuse switches, the fuses are not supplied
by default. Fuses may be selected as follows:

24 RK5: 1.25x FLC


RK1: 1.3x FLC
Class J: 1.5x FLC
25
Table 29.3-7. Combination Starters with Fusible SwitchesDimensions in Inches (mm)
26 NEMA Maximum Horsepower Switch Freedom
Size Rating 1 Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
27 Full Voltage Non-ReversingFusible Type F204
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 12.00 (304.8) 2X
28 2 10 15 25 25 25 60 12.00 (304.8) 2X
3 25 30 50 50 50 60/100 24.00 (609.6) 4X
4 40 50 75 100 100 100/200 36.00 (914.4) 6X
29 5 75 100 150 200 200 400 2 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
66.00 (1676.4) 11X
62 150 200 300 400 400 600 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
30 Full Voltage ReversingFusible Type F214
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 18.00 (457.2) 3X
31 2 10 15 25 25 25 60 18.00 (457.2) 3X
3 25 30 50 50 50 100/200 30.00 (762.0) 5X
4 40 50 75 100 100 200 40.00 (1016.0) 8X
32 5 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
6 150 200 300 400 400 600 72.00 (1828.8) 12X

33 Two-Speed One WindingFusible Type F944


1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 24.00 (609.6) 4X
2 10 15 25 25 25 60 24.00 (609.6) 4X
34 3 25 30 30 50 60
25 30 50 50 50 100 36.00 (914.4) 6X
4 60 100
35 40 50 75 100 100 200 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
Two-Speed Two WindingFusible Type F954
36 1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 24.00 (609.6) 4X
2 10 15 25 25 25 60 24.00 (609.6) 4X
37 30 60
3 25 30 50 50 50 100 30.00 (762.0) 5X
60 100
38 4 40 50 75 100 100 200 60.00 (1524.6) 10X
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
Reduced Voltage AutotransformerFusible Type F604
39 2 10 15 25 25 25 60 36.00 (914.4) 6X
3 25 30 50 50 50 100 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
40 4 40 50 75 100 100 200 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
6 150 200 300 400 400 600 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
41 1 Combination fused starter units rated 100 kAIC short-circuit current.
2 Certain items in unit option Groups B and C may require additional space. See Page 29.2-17.

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.3-7
January 2016 Freedom
Sheet 29 051
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.3-7. Combination Starters with Fusible SwitchesDimensions in Inches (mm) (Continued)
NEMA Maximum Horsepower Switch Freedom 22
Size Rating 1 Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space 23
Reduced Voltage Part WindingFusible Type F704
1PW 10 10 15 15 15 60 36.00 (914.4) 6X
15 25 30 40 60 36.00 (914.4) 6X 24
2PW 20 25 40 40 100 36.00 (914.4) 6X
50 60 100 40.00 (1016.0) 8X
3PW 40 50 75 75 75 200 40.00 (1016.0) 8X 25
50 100 100 150 200 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
4PW 75 75 150 150 400 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
100 100 200 250 300 400 26
5PW 150 150 250 350 350 600 72.00 (1828.8) 2 12X 2
Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Open TransitionFusible Type F804
15 15 30 40 40 60
27
2YD 20 25 40 100 30.00 (762.0) 5X
25 30 50 60 75 100
3YD 40 50 75 75 200 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
28
50 60 100 125 150 200
4YD 60 75 150 150 400 72.00 (1828.8) 2 12X 2
100 125 200 250 300 400
29
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 72.00 (1828.8) 2 12X 2



200

350

400
350
500
400
600
30
250 250 400 500 700 800 72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3
6YD 300 350 500 700 700 1200
Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Closed TransitionFusible Type F894 31
15 15 30 40 40 60
2YD 20 25 40 100 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
25 30 50 60 75 100
32
3YD 40 50 75 75 200 66.00 (1676.4) 11X
72.00 (1828.8) 2 12X 2
4YD
50
60
60
75
100
150
125
150
50 200
400 72.00 (1828.8) 2 12X 2
33
100 125 200 250 300 400
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 72.00 (1828.8) 2 12X 2
350 400
34
200 350 400 500 600
6YD 250 250 400 500 700 800 72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3
300 350 500 700 700 1200 35
1 Combination fused starter units rated 100 kAIC short-circuit current.
2 Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
3 Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide and 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep section. 36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.3-8 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom January 2016
Sheet 29 052
Layout and Technical Data

S811+ Solid-State Reduced Voltage StarterFusible Switch Motor Service Factor (SF) Effect on S811+ Starter Selection
22 Eatons S811+ solid-state reduced voltage starter uses SCRs A 1.0 service factor motor may draw up to
when starting and a low impedance run circuit during 1.00 x full load amperes
operation. The S811+ solid-state starter has five 24 Vdc A 1.15 service factor motor may draw up to
23 inputs and two relay outputs. S811+ soft start units include a 1.15 x full load amperes (15% more current).
disconnect, a starter, 24 Vdc power supply and 100 VA CPT. This chart is based off of a 1.15 SF motor selection.
24 S811+ starters are current rated devices. In some cases,
a larger S811+ SSRV starter must be supplied for 1.15 SF
motors. See the maximum horsepower chart below
25 Table 29.3-8. Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty RatingsFusible
S811+ S811+ 208 V 230 V 380 V 460 V 575 V Inches X
26 Amperage Frame hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse (mm) Space

Standard Duty
37 65 10 50 70 30/60 10 50 70 30/60 15 50 70 30/60 20 50 70 30/60 30 50 80 30/60 18 (457.2) 3X
27 66 65 15 100 125 100 20 100 125 100 30 100 150 100 40 100 150 100 50 100 150 100 18 (457.2) 3X
105 110 30 150 225 200 30 150 200 200 45 150 150 200 60 150 150 200 75 150 200 200 18 (457.2) 3X
135 110 40 150 225 200 40 150 250 200 55 150 250 200 75 150 250 200 100 150 250 200 18 (457.2) 3X
28 180 200 50 250 400 400 60 250 350 400 75 250 350 400 125 250 400 400 150 250 350 400 36 (914.4) 6X
240 200 60 250 400 400 75 250 450 400 110 400 500 400 150 400 500 400 200 250 450 400 36 (914.4) 6X
304 200 75 400 600 400 100 400 600 600 132 400 600 600 200 400 600 600 250 400 600 600 36 (914.4) 6X
29 360 290 100 400 700 600 125 400 800 600 160 600 800 600 300 400 800 600 54 (1371.6) 9X
420 290 125 600 900 600 200 600 1000 800 300 600 1000 800 350 600 900 600 54 (1371.6) 9X
500 290 150 600 1000 800 250 600 1000 800 350 600 1000 800 450 600 1000 800 54 (1371.6) 9X
30 650
720
290
290
200 1200

1200 1200 200 1200
250 1200
1200 800 315
1200 1200
1200

1200 1200 450 1200
500 1200
1200 1200 600 1200
1200 1200
1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
72 (1828.8) 12X
850 290 300 1200 1200 1200 375 1200 1200 1200 600 1200 2000 1200 700 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
31 1000 290 350 2000 2000 1200 500 2000 2000 1200 700 2000 2000 1200 900 2000 2000 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
Severe Duty
22 65 5 70 40 5 70 35 7.5 60 35 10 60 35 15 70 40 18 (457.2) 3X
32 42
65
65
110
10
15
125 70
200 110
10
20
125 70
200 125
18.5
22
150
150
90 25
100 40
150
150
80
125
30
50
125 80 18 (457.2)
200 125 18 (457.2)
3X
3X
80 110 20 225 150 25 300 175 37 300 175 50 250 150 60 250 150 18 (457.2) 3X
33 115
150
200
200
30
40
300 225
350 250
30
50
350 200 55
400 300


300 250 75
100
300 225 100
400 300 125
300 250 36 (914.4)
400 300 36 (914.4)
6X
6X
192 200 50 400 350 60 500 350 90 500 400 125 500 400 150 400 350 36 (914.4) 6X
34 240
305
290
290
60
75
500 400
700 500

100
110
800 600 132


600 500 150
800 600 200
600 450
800 600 250
54 (1371.6) 9X
800 600 54 (1371.6) 9X
365 290 100 900 700 125 1000 800 160 900 700 250 1000 700 300 900 700 72 (1828.8) 12X
420 290 125 1000 800 200 1200 800 300 1200 800 350 1000 800 72 (1828.8) 12X
35 480 290 150 1200 800 220 1200 1000 350 1200 1000 450 1200 1000 72 (1828.8) 12X
525 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
600 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
36
Table 29.3-9. Control Options Table 29.3-11. FLA Ratings
Extra 50 VA Control Power Transformer 1 Ramp Current % Ramp Starts Similar to
37 24 Vdc Control 1 of FLA Time Per Hour Starting Method
Line or Load MOV Protection 1 Standard Duty
Pump Control Option 1
38 1 Option fits in standard unit space.
300%
500%
30 Seconds
10 Seconds
3
3
Soft start
Full voltage
350% 20 Seconds 3 Wye delta
Table 29.3-10. Option Sizing for Isolating Contactor and Bypass Starter 480% 20 Seconds 2 80% RVAT
39 S811+ Fused Starter Option FlashGard Structure 390% 20 Seconds 3 65% RVAT
Width Switch Size Unit Size Unit Size Width 300% 20 Seconds 4 50% RVAT
(mm) Type Inches Inches Inches Severe Duty
40 (Amperes) (mm) (mm) (mm)
450% 30 seconds 4 Soft start
65 30/60/100 1, 2, 3 36.00 (914.4) 36.00 (914.4) 20.00 (508.0) 500% 10 seconds 10 Full voltage
110 100 3 42.00 (1066.8) 42.00 (1066.8) 20.00 (508.0) 350% 65 seconds 3 Wye delta
41 110 200 4 54.00 (1371.6) 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0) 480% 25 seconds 4 80% RVAT
200 400/800 5, 6 72.00 (1828.8) 72.00 (1828.8) 32.00 (812.8) 390% 40 seconds 4 65% RVAT
290 600/800 6 72.00 (1828.8) 72.00 (1828.8) 36.00 (914.4) 300% 60 seconds 4 50% RVAT
42 290 800/1200 7 72.00 (1828.8) 72.00 (1828.8) 64.00 (1625.6)

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.3-9
January 2016 Freedom
Sheet 29 053
Layout and Technical Data

SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drive Units CT (IH): High overload drives are capable of producing 200%
All Eatons standard units include a disconnect, an AC choke,
starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 150% overload 22
for one minute. Essentially a constant torque drive.
an output reactor and a door-mounted keypad. All plug-in
units have a built-in dynamic braking circuit through the FR5 VT (IL): Low overload drives are capable of producing 200%
frame size. Drive units that require door-mounted fans also starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 110% overload
23
include a CPT. for one minute. Essentially a variable torque drive.
Note: Output reactor not included on 240 V units. 24
Table 29.3-12. SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency DrivesDimensions in Inches (mm)
AFD Unit Nominal (VT) (CT) Branch Protection Min Typical Maximum 25
Frame hp IL IH HMCP T.M. K-SW Height (X) Width Height (X) Width Height (X) Width
Amperes Amperes
200240 V 26
FR4 Drawout 0.75 3.7 3.7 7 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
1.0 4.8 4.8 15 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
1.5 6.6 6.6 15 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 27
2.0 7.8 7.8 15 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
3.0 11.0 15 25 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
3.0 11.0 15 25 30 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
28
FR5 Drawout 5.0 17.5 17.5 30 40 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
7.5 25.0 25.0 50 50 60 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
10.0 31.0 50 70 60 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) X6 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
FR6 Drawout 10.0 31.0 31.0 50 60 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
29
15.0 48.0 48.0 100 100 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
20.0 61.0 100 125 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
FR7 Fixed 20.0 61.0 100 125 100 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
30
25.0 75.0 75.0 100 175 200 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
30.0 88.0 88.0 100 220 200 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
35.0 114.0 150 285 200 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0) 31
380500 V
FR4 Drawout 1.0 2.2 2.2 7 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
1.5 3.3 3.3 7 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 32
2.0 4.3 4.3 7 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
3.0 5.6 5.6 15 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
5.0
5.0
7.6
7.6
15
15
25
25
30
30
18.0 (457.2)
24.0 (609.6)
3X
4X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
30.0 (762.0)
36.0 (914.4)
5X
6X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
36.0 (914.4)
42.0 (1066.8)
6X
7X
20.0 (508.0)
20.2 (508.0)
33
7.5 12.0 30 25 30 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
FR5 Drawout 7.5
10.0

16.0
12.0
16.0
30
30
25
35
30
30
24.0 (609.6)
24.0 (609.6)
4X
4X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
42.0 (1066.8)
42.0 (1066.8)
7X
7X
20.2 (508.0)
20.2 (508.0)
34
15.0 23.0 23.0 30 50 60 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
20.0 31.0 50 60 60 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
FR6 Drawout 20.0 31.0 50 60 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
35
25.0 38.0 38.0 50 80 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
30.0 46.0 46.0 100 100 80 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
40.0 61.0 100 125 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0) 36
FR7 Fixed 40.0 61.0 100 125 100 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
50.0 72.0 72.0 100 150 100 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
60.0
75.0
87.0
105.0
87.0 100
150
175
225
100
175
54.0 (8229.6)
54.0 (8229.6)
9X
9X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)






72.0 (1828.8)
72.0 (1828.8)
12X
12X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
37
FR8 Fixed 75.0 105.0 150 225 175 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 32.0 (812.8)
100.0
125.0
140.0
170.0
140.0
170.0
150
250
300
400
200
250
72.0 (1828.8)
72.0 (1828.8)
12X
12X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)






72.0 (1828.8)
72.0 (1828.8)
12X
12X
32.0 (812.8)
32.0 (812.8)
38
150.0 205.0 400 500 350 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 32.0 (812.8)
205.0 400 500 350 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 28.0 (711.2) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 40.0 (1016.0)
FR9 Fixed 150.0
200.0 261.0 261.0 400 600 450 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 28.0 (711.2) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 40.0 (1016.0)
39
250.0 1 300.0 400 700 500 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 28.0 (711.2) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 40.0 (1016.0)
FR10 Fixed 250.0 300.0 400 700 500 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
300.0 385.0 385.0 600 800 600 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0) 40
350.0 460.0 460.0 600 1000 800 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
400.0 520.0 1200 1200 800 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
FR11 Fixed 400.0 590.0 1200 1200 1000 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0) 41
500.0 650.0 650.0 1200 1500 1000 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
550.0 730.0 730.0 1200 1600 1200 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
FR12 Fixed 600.0 820.0 1200 1600 1200 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 128.0 (3251.2) 42
1 If a 250 hp 40 C rating is required, then up-size to the FR10. This FR9 sizing is only valid at 30 C ambient.
Note: FR9 and larger AFD units require a 21.00 inch (533.4 mm) deep enclosure. FR11 and FR12 are non UL designs; consult factory for
specific application. In drawout, minimum does not contain an operator panel, typical contains a device panel and room for timers and relays, 43
maximum makes provisions for isolation contactors and bypass. In fixed, minimum contains a device panel and room for timers and relays,
maximum makes provisions for isolation contactors and bypass. Consult factory for NEMA 3R sizing.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.3-10 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom January 2016
Sheet 29 054
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.3-13. Adjustable Frequency Drives Passive Filters Addition Table 29.3-15. Options
22 Hp SVX Drive Passive Input Height Unit Space Plug-in Options
(Maximum) (Amperes) (Amperes) (X) Option Boards 4
23 1
1.5
2.2
3.3
6
6
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
I/O Expander 5

5
Encoder Expander
3 5.6 6 36.0 (914.4) 6X Interbus S Communications 5
5
24 5
7.5
7.6
12
8
14
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
Modbus Communications
PROFIBUS DP Communications 5

10 16 21 36.0 (914.4) 6X LonWorks Communications 5

Can Open (Slave) Communications 5


15 23 27 36.0 (914.4) 6X
25 20 31 34 36.0 (914.4) 6X DeviceNet Communications 6

25 38 44 36.0 (914.4) 6X Johnson Controls N2 Communications 5

PROFIBUS DP (D9 Connector) 5


30 46 52 48.0 (1219.2) 8X
26 40 61 66 48.0 (1219.2) 8X EtherNet/IP Communications 5

50 72 83 48.0 (1219.2) Modbus TCP Communications 5


8X
Modbus (D9 Connector) 5
60 87 103 48.0 (1219.2) 8X
27 75 105 128 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Plug-in Control Relays
100 140 165 60.0 (1524.0) 10X One relay 7

125 170 208 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Two relays 7

28 150 205 208 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Three relays 8

200 261 320 72.0 (1828.8) 12X Other Options


Note: Passive filters are a separate unit located next to the connected AFD. Passive filters Automatic bypass circuit 9
29 can reduce THD of the connected AFD to 8% or less. Passive filters are not interlocked to the Bypass drive test switch 9
AFD compartment. Seven relay 120V control with CPT 7

Isolated signal processor 5

30 Table 29.3-14. SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives in NEMA 3R MCCs 315 PSIG interface 5

Dimensions in Inches (mm) 1 Dynamic breaking resistors j

Graphics keypad 6
IH Nominal IL Nominal CB Type 3 Unit Space (Typ./Max)
31 Amperes hp IH 2 Amperes hp IL HMCP MCCB Dim. (X) Line fuses 57

RFI filter 6
380500 V
Deduct to remove output filter k
2.2 1.0 3.3 1.5 7 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X
32 3.3 1.5 4.3 2.0 7 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X V1K 2000 ft (610m) Dv/Dt filter 8

4.3 2.0 5.6 3.0 7 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X Output contactor 5


5.6 3.0 7.6 5.0 15 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X
33 7.6 5.0 12.0 7.5 15 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X Dual overloads 58

Three contactor bypass 58


12.0 7.5 16.0 10.0 30 25 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
16.0 10.0 23.0 15.0 30 35 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 4 Up to five option boards may be selected.
34 23.0
31.0
15.0
20.0
31.0
38.0
20.0
25.0
30
50
50
60
72.00 (1828.8)
72.00 (1828.8)
12X
12X
Please see Tab 31 for detailed information.
5 All options will fit in typical and maximum
38.0 25.0 46.0 30.0 50 80 72.00 (1828.8) 12X option unit.
35 46.0 30.0 61.0 40.0 100 100 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 6
7
This option will fit in all units.
One of these options will fit in 530 hp CT at
1 This table is common for both Freedom and Freedom FlashGard MCC.
2 A separate CPT bucket is provided for all AFDs (15 hp) listed in the table. 480 V frame standard units, 130 hp CT at
480 V typical and maximum option units.
36 3 For fusible disconnect, use typical option unit. 8 All options will fit in maximum option unit.
Note: Drive units fit into a standard 20.00-inch (508.0 mm) wide structure. 9 Use with bypass option.
j DB resistors are to be mounted by the
37 customer external to the MCC.
k Not available for 240V units.
Note: Output reactor or Dv/Dt filter not
38 required for motor lead lengths shorter
than 100 feet (30.4 m)30 feet (9.1 m) for
2 hp and below).
39 Note: Maximum motor lead length is
160 feet (48.8 m) for 1.5 hp and below,
330 feet (100.6 m) for 2 hp and 400 feet
(121.9 m) for 3 hp and larger when using
40 a standard output reactor.
Note: Motor lead lengths up to 2000 feet
(609.6 m) can be achieved by using a
41 Dv/Dt filter.

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.3-11
January 2016 Freedom
Sheet 29 055
Layout and Technical Data

CPX9000 Clean Power Drives IH (CT): High overload drives are


1500 hp at 480V capable of producing 200% starting 22
torque for 10 seconds and are rated
Eatons CPX9000 Clean Power Drives 150% overload for one minute.
use advanced 18-pulse, clean-power Essentially a constant torque drive. 23
technology that significantly reduces
IL (VT): Low overload drives are
line harmonics at the drive input
capable of producing 200% starting
terminals, resulting in one of the
torque for 10 seconds and are rated
24
purest sinusoidal waveforms.
110% overload for one minute.
Essentially a variable torque drive.
25
Table 29.3-16. CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives, Thermal-Magnetic Breaker and Motor Circuit Protector (MCP) Disconnect
Dimensions in Inches (mm) 26
Low Overload Drive 1 High Overload Drive 1 CB Type 2 Standard Unit Space Dimensions Inches (mm) 3
IL Nominal hp IH Nominal hp HMCP MCCB Width Height Depth (X)
Amperes IL Amperes IH 27
34 25 4 27 20 4 50 80 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
40
52
30 4
40 4
34
40
25 4
30 4
100
100
100
125
40.00 (1016.0)
40.00 (1016.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
21.00 (533.4)
21.00 (533.4)
12X
12X
28
65 50 4 52 40 4 100 150 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
77
96
60 4
75 4
65
77
50 4
60 4
100
150
175
225
40.00 (1016.0)
40.00 (1016.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
21.00 (533.4)
21.00 (533.4)
12X
12X
29
124 100 4 96 75 4 150 300 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
156 125 4 124 100 4 250 400 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
180 150 4 156 125 4 400 400 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X 30
240 200 180 150 600 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
302 250 240 200 600 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
361 300 5 302 250 5 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 31
414 350 5 361 300 5 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
477 400 5 414 350 5 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
515 450 5 477 400 5 1200 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 32
590 500 5 515 450 5 1200 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
1 The CPX9000 drive uses the term Low Overload (IL) in place of the term Variable Torque and High Overload (IH) in place of the term
Constant Torque. 33
2 CPX9000 Drives in MCCs are available in thermal-magnetic breaker, motor circuit protector and fused disconnect configurations.
3 A minimum clearance of 4.00 inches (101.6 mm) should be provided at the back of CPX9000 Drive MCC section for ventilation.
4 Add 32.00 inches (812.8 mm) of width for bypass. 34
5 Required transformer section is 28.00 (711.2) deep. CPX and bypass is 21.00 (533.4) deep.

Table 29.3-17. CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives, Fusible Switch DisconnectDimensions in Inches (mm) 35
Low Overload Drive 6 High Overload Drive 6 Fuse Switch Standard Unit Space Dimensions Inches (mm) 7
IL Nominal hp IH Nominal hp Fuse Switch Width Height Depth (X)
Amperes IL Amperes IH 36
34 25 h 27 20 h 50 60 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
40 30 h 34 25 h 60 60 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X 37
52 40 h 40 30 h 80 100 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
65 50 h 52 40 h 100 100 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
77
96
60 h
75 h
65
77
50 h
60 h
100
100
100
100
40.00 (1016.0)
40.00 (1016.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
21.00 (533.4)
21.00 (533.4)
12X
12X
38
124 100 h 96 75 h 175 200 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
156
180
125 h
150 h
124
156
100 h
125 h
200
250
200
400
40.00 (1016.0)
40.00 (1016.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
90.00 (2286.0)
21.00 (533.4)
21.00 (533.4)
12X
12X
39
240 200 180 150 350 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
302 250 240 200 450 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
361 300 i 302 250 i 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 40
414 350 i 361 300 i 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
477 400 i 414 350 i 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
515 450 i 477 400 i 800 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 41
590 500 i 515 450 i 800 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
6 The CPX9000 product uses the term Low Overload (IL) in place of the term Variable Torque and High Overload (IH) in place of the term
Constant Torque.
42
7 A minimum clearance of 4.00 inches (101.6 mm) should be provided at the back of CPX9000 Drive MCC section for ventilation.
h Add 32.00 inches (812.8 mm) of width for bypass.
i Required transformer section is 28.00 (711.2) deep. CPX and bypass is 21.00 (533.4) deep. 43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.3-12 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom January 2016
Sheet 29 056
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.3-18. Main Incoming Line and Feeder Circuit BreakersMolded-Case Circuit BreakersDimensions in Inches (mm)
22 Frames reflect standard circuit breakers. Unit spacings shown include sufficient space to terminate cables on any standard
breaker lug. If cable sizes exceed those listed, add 12.00-inch (304.8 mm) space for lug adapters.
23 Frame Size
(Amperes)
Circuit Breaker
Frame
Interrupting Capacity (kAIC) Main Unit Size Feeder Unit Size Maximum
Cable Size 1
240 V 480 V 575 V Inches (mm) X Space Inches (mm) X Space

125 E125H 100 65 25 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 1X 7 or 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
24 150 HFD 100 65 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
150 FDC 100 100 35 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
225 HFD 100 65 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 4/0 (one per phase)
25 225 J250 100 100 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 18.00 (457.2) 1X 7 or 3X 4/0 (one per phase)
FDC 100 100 35
250 J250 100 65 25 24.00 (609.6) 4X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 350 kcmil (one per phase)
26 JDC 100 100 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X
400 HKD 100 65 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X 30.00 (762.0) 4X 250 kcmil (two per phase)
KDC 100 100 50 or 500 kcmil
27 CHKD 2 100 65 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X 30.00 (762.0) 5X (one per phase)
CKDC 2 100 100 50
600 HLD 100 65 35 24.00 (609.6) 4X 30.00 (762.0) 5X 500 kcmil (two per phase)
28 LDC 100 100 50
CHLD 23 100 65 35 4X 24.00 (609.6) 4X
CLDC 23 100 100 50
29 800 NGC 100 100 50 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 750 kcmil (three per phase)
NGH-C 2 100 65 35 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
NGC-C 2 100 100 50
30 1200 NGH 4 100 65 35 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 750 kcmil (three per phase)
NGC 4 100 100 50

31 NGH-C 23
NGC-C 23
100
100
65
100
35
50
72.00 (1828.8) 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X

2000 RGH 4 100 65 50 72.00 (1828.8) 5 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 750 kcmil (six per phase)
RGC 3 100 100 65
32 RGH-C 2 100 65 50
RGC-C 2 100 100 65
2500 RGH 100 65 50 72.00 (1828.8) 56 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 750 kcmil (six per phase)
33 RGC 100 65 50
1 See circuit breaker terminal data for variations.
2 Digitrip 310+ LS is required and included in the price.
34 3 NEMA 1 gasketed only.
4 Digitrip 310+ LS is standard and included in the pricing.
5 The main breaker requires the complete vertical section. The rear is unusable.
35 6 24.00-inch (609.6 mm) wide.
7 Compact feeder units.

36 Table 29.3-19. Main Circuit BreakersMagnum DS Air Circuit Breakers Manually or Electrically Operated
Fixed MountedDimensions in Inches (mm)
Frame Size Circuit Breaker Interrupting Capacity (kAIC) Unit Enclosure Enclosure
37 Amperes Type 240 V 480 V 575 V Size Width Depth

800 MDS-608 65 65 65 72.00 (1828.8) 24.00 (609.6) 21.00 (533.4)


38 MDS-C08 100 100 100
1600 MDS-616 65 65 65
MDS-C16 100 100 100
39 2000 MDS-620 65 65 65
MDS-C20 100 100 100
Note: A 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) filler section must be added between the main and the rest of the MCC to allow for door opening.
40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.3-13
January 2016 Freedom
Sheet 29 057
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.3-20. Main Circuit Breakers Magnum DS Air Circuit Breakers, Manually or Electrically Operated
Drawout MountedDimensions in Inches (mm) 22
Frame Size Circuit Breaker Interrupting Capacity (kAIC) Unit Enclosure Enclosure
(Amperes) Type 240 V 480 V 575 V Size Width Depth
23
800 MDS-608 65 65 65 72.00 (1828.8) 24.00 (609.6) 1 42.00 (1066.8) 2
MDS-C08 100 100 100
1600 MDS-616 65 65 65 24
MDS-C16 100 100 100
2000 MDS-620 65 65 65
MDS-C20 100 100 100 25
3200 MDS-632 65 65 65
MDS-C32 100 100 100
1 A 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) filler section must be added between the main and the rest of the MCC to allow for door opening. 26
2 Structure is rear aligned.

Table 29.3-21. Digitrip Units Table 29.3-23. Freedom Main Incoming Line and Feeder 27
Type Unit Space Fusible SwitchesDimensions in Inches (mm)
Inches (mm) Three-pole250 V or 600 Vac. Fuses not included.
Switch Fuse Unit Space
28
RMS 3101150 Refer to Page 21.4-10
for more details. Rating 5 Clip Size Incoming Line Feeder
Amps 6 Amps
Options Inches (mm) X Space Inches (mm) X Space 29
Tie breaker 3 72.00 (1828.8) or 12X
30 30 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 2X
Electrically operated
60 60 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 2X
Accessories 30/30 Dual 30/30 Dual 12.00 (304.8) 2X 30
UV release-instantaneous 30/60 Dual 30/60 Dual 12.00 (304.8) 2X
Shunt trip (standard on electrically operated 60/60 Dual 60/60 Dual 12.00 (304.8) 2X
breakers) 100 100 18.00 (457.2) 3X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 31
Key interlock on breaker 200 200 30.00 (762.0) 5X 30.00 (762.0) 5X
Auxiliary switch (3A/3B) 400 400 48.00 (1219.2) 8X 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
Cell position switch
Operations counter


600
800
600
800
54.00 (1371.8) h 9X h
48.00 (1219.2) i 8X i
48.00 (1219.2) 8X
48.00 (1219.2) j 8X j
32
Auxiliary power module (to test Digitrip) 1200 g 1200 60.00 (1524.0) 10X 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
Portable lift truck
Manual close pushbutton cover


5
6
Suitable for 100,000 A interrupting if Class RK fuses are used. 33
Type of SW K-SW 30800 A.
3 Tie breaker adds an additional 20.00-inch (508.0 mm) wide bus g High magnetic molded-case switch.
transition section. Also two 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) filler sections will
be added to the MCC if the tie breaker is located in the center of
h
i
For bottom cable entry, add 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) or 1X space.
For bottom entry, add 12.00 inches (304.8 mm) or 2X space.
34
the MCC lineup. If the tie breaker is located between the two main j For top entry, add 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) or 1X space.
structures, the two 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) fillers are not needed.
35
Table 29.3-22. Main-Tie-Main Auto Throw-Over Options
Option Description
36
AT200 Standard PLC-based control scheme. No operator interface
(PanelMate) provided. Sequence of operations and external
controls are pre-defined and not subject to customer
modifications. Type of voltage sensing device must be
37
chosen. If closed-transition operation is required, a
sync-check relay (device 25) must be used.
AT300 Same as AT200, except includes operator interface 38
(PanelMate). 4
AT300X Same as AT200, except customer modifications are acceptable.
This is the proper choice for PLC-based systems with special 39
sequences, more than main-tie-main configurations, and/or
where special PanelMate page layouts are required.
AT300IQ Standard Automatic Transfer Control (ATC) controller-based 40
control scheme for main-main configurations. Either or both
sources may be generators. Includes manual-auto operation,
and generator control switch. If closed-transition operation is
required, a sync-check relay (device 25) must be used.
41
4 Operator interface page layouts are pre-defined and not subject to
customer modifications.
42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.3-14 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 058

This page intentionally left blank.


22

23

24

25

26

27

28

29

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.4-1
January 2016 Freedom Arc Resistant
Sheet 29 059
General Description

Freedom Arc Resistant Quick Reference Layout Guide Index


22
Device Space Requirements Table Page
Short-Circuit Ratings for Motor Control (480 V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-1 29.4-2
Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors 23
or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-2 29.4-2
Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-3 29.4-5 24
Option Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-4 29.4-5
Control Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-5 29.4-5
FLA Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-6 29.4-5
25
SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-7 29.4-6
Adjustable Frequency Drives Passive Filters Addition. . . . . . . . . 29.4-8 29.4-7 26
Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-9 29.4-7
Main Incoming Line and Feeder Circuit Breakers 27
Freedom Arc Resistant
Molded-Case Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.4-10 29.4-8
Motor Control Center
28
General Description
Eatons Freedom Arc Resistant motor
29
control center is the first MCC to be
tested to a North American guideline 30
specifically written for low voltage
MCCs, unlike C37.20.7 that is a
guideline for testing metal-enclosed 31
switchgear up to 38 kV. Eatons
Freedom Arc Resistant motor
control center is tested in accordance
with CSA C22.2 No. 0.22-11 titled
32
Evaluation methods for arc resistant
ratings of enclosed electrical 33
equipment.

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.4-2 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom Arc Resistant January 2016
Sheet 29 060
Layout and Technical Data

22 Technical Data
Table 29.4-1. Short-Circuit Ratings for Motor Control (480 V)
Short-Circuit Combination Starter Solid-State Adjustable
23 Protective Device FV and RV (kA) Reduced Voltage (kA) Frequency Drives (kA)

HMCP motor circuit protector (standard rating) 65 65 65


24 HMCP motor circuit protector (optional rating) 100 100 100
MCCB molded-case circuit breaker (standard rating) 65 65 65
MCCB molded-case circuit breaker (optional rating) 100 100
Fusible switch 100 100 100
25
Table 29.4-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers
26 Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors.
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP/HMCPE MCCB Freedom Arc Resistant
27 Size Frame 12 Frame 3 Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
Full Voltage Non-Reversing Type F206
28 125 E 6.00 (152.4) 4 1X 4
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 12.00 (304.8) 5 2X 5
18.00 (457.2) 3X
29 125 E 6.00 (152.4) 4 1X 4
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 12.00 (304.8) 5 2X 5
18.00 (457.2) 3X
30 125 E 12.00 (304.8) 4 2X 4
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 18.00 (457.2) 6 3X 6
24.00 (609.6) 4X
31 4 40 50 75 100 100 150
HFD/FDC
HJD/JDC
12.00 (304.8) 7
18.00 (457.2) 67
2X
3X 6
24.00 (609.6) 7 4X
32 5
50
75
60
100
100
150
125
200
150
200
250
400
HJD/JDC
HKD/KDC
36.00 (914.4) 6X

Full Voltage Reversing Type F216


33 1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10
125
150
E
HFD/FDC
18.00 (457.2) 6
24.00 (609.6)
3X 6
4X
125 E 18.00 (457.2) 6 3X 6
34 2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X
3 25 30 50 50 50 125/150 HFD/FDC/E 24.00 (609.6) 8 6X
4 40 50 75 100 100 150 HJD/JDC 30.00 (762.0) 8 5X
35 50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC
1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE magnetic only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V. Optional
36 HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V.
2 E-Frame motor circuit protection available for size 13 starters only.
3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
37 4
5
Maximum of (three) pilot devices, (two) auxiliary contacts 100 VA CPT maximum. Standard lugs only.
1200 A HMCP frame available in 11X 66.00-inch (1676.4 mm).
6 For top entry, 8X space required.
38 7
8
Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
30.00-inch (762.0 mm) space needed for thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.4-3
January 2016 Freedom Arc Resistant
Sheet 29 061
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.4-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers (Continued)
Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors. 22
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP MCCB Freedom Arc Resistant
Size Frame 12 Frame 23
Unit Size 23
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
Two-Speed One Winding, Constant/Variable Torque Type F946 24
125 E
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X
125 E 25
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X
125 E
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HJD/JDC 36.00 (914.4) 45 6X 26
150 HFD/FDC
4 40 50 75 100 100 250 HJD/JDC 36.00 (914.4) 45 6X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 27
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 6 12X
Two-Speed Two Winding, Constant/Variable Torque Type F956
125 E 28
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X
125 E
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4 4X 29
3 125 E
25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 4 5X
30 40 60 75 100 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 4 5X 30
4 40 50 75 100 250 HJD/JDC 30.00 (762.0) 4 5X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 6 12X 31
Reduced Voltage Autotransformer Type F606
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 36.00 (914.4) 6X
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
32
4 30 50 75 100 100 150 HJD/JDC 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 33
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
Reduced Voltage Part Winding Type F706
1PW 10 10 15 15 15 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 8 4X 34
2PW 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 8 4X
30.00 (762.0) 8
3PW 40 50 75 75 75 150 HFD/FDC 5X
35
100 125 150 HFD/FDC
60 60 125 150 150 250 HJD/JDC
4PW 75 75 150 400 HKD/KDC 36.00 (914.4) 8 6X
100 125 250 300 400 HKD/KDC
36
5PW 150 150 250 350 350 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 7 12X
1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE Magnetic Only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,00 0A at 480 V. Optional
HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V.
37
2 E-Frame motor circuit protector available through size 3 starter only.
3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
4 Add 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space for low speed disconnect.
38
5 42.00-inch (1066.8 mm) space needed with Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker. 48.00-inch (1219.2 mm) space needed with thermal-magnetic
circuit breaker.
6 Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure. 39
7 Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep, 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
8 For starting speed disconnect, add 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space.
40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.4-4 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom Arc Resistant January 2016
Sheet 29 062
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.4-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers (Continued)
22 Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors.
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP MCCB Freedom Arc Resistant
23 Size Frame 12 Frame 23
Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space

24 Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Open Transition 4 Type F806


2YD 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 5X
30 40 75 75 5 150 HFD/FDC
25 3YD 40 50 250 HJD/JDC 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
60 75 125 150 150 250 HJD/JDC
4YD 150 400 HKD/KDC 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
26 100 125 200 250 300 400 HKD/KDC
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 4 12X
Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Closed Transition 4 Type F896
27 2YD 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 42.00 (1066.8) 7X
3YD 40 50 250 HFD/FDC 54.00 (1371.6) 9X

28 4YD
60

75 125
150
150

150

250
400
HJD/JDC
HKD/KDC 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
100 125 200 250 300 400 HKD/KDC
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 4 12X
29 1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE magnetic only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V. Optional
HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V.
2 E-Frame motor circuit protector available through size 3 starter only.
30 3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
4 Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep, 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.4-5
January 2016 Freedom Arc Resistant
Sheet 29 063
Layout and Technical Data

S811+ Solid-State Reduced Voltage Starter Motor Service Factor (SF) Effect on S811+ Starter Selection
Eatons S811+ solid-state reduced voltage starter uses SCRs A 1.0 service factor motor may draw up to 22
when starting and a low impedance run circuit during 1.00 x full load amperes
operation. The S811+ solid-state starter has five 24 Vdc A 1.15 service factor motor may draw up to
inputs and two relay outputs. S811+ soft start units include 1.15 x full load amperes (15% more current). This 23
a disconnect, starter, 24 Vdc power supply and 100 VA CPT. chart is based off of a 1.15 SF motor selection
S811+ starters are current rated devices. In some cases,
a larger S811+ SSRV starter must be supplied for 1.15 SF
24
motors. See the maximum horsepower chart below
Table 29.4-3. Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty Ratings 1 25
S811+ S811+ 208 V 230 V 380 V 460 V 575 V Inches X Space
Amperage Frame (mm)
hp HMCP T.M. hp HMCP T.M. hp HMCP T.M. hp HMCP T.M. hp HMCP T.M.
26
37 65 10 50 70 10 50 70 15 50 70 20 50 70 30 50 80 18.00 (457.2) 3X
66 65 15 100 125 20 100 125 100 50 150 40 100 150 50 100 150
105 110 30 150 225 30 150 200 150 75 150 60 150 150 75 150 200 18.00 (457.2) 3X
135 110 40 150 225 40 150 250 150 100 250 75 150 250 100 150 250 27
180 200 50 250 400 60 250 350 250 150 350 125 250 400 150 250 350 36.00 (914.4) 6X
240 200 60 250 400 75 250 450 110 200 500 150 400 500 200 250 400
304 200 75 400 600 100 400 600 132 250 600 200 400 600 250 400 600
Severe Duty
28
22 65 5 70 5 70 7.5 60 10 60 15 70 18.00 (457.2) 3X
42 65 10 125 10 125 18.5 150 25 150 30 125
65 110 15 200 20 200 22 150 40 150 50 200 18.00 (457.2) 3X 29
80 110 20 225 25 300 37 300 50 250 60 250
115 200 30 300 30 350 55 300 75 300 100 300 36.00 (914.4) 6X
150 200 40 350 50 400 100 400 125 400
192 200 50 400 60 500 90 500 125 500 150 400 30
1 Standard-duty ratings reflect the maximum starting duty that these units are designed to supply.

Table 29.4-4. Option SizingDimensions in Inches (mm) Table 29.4-5. Control Options 31
S811+ Disconnect Starter Option Unit Structure Extra 50 VA Control Power Transformer 45
Width Type Size Size 2 Width 24 Vdc Control 4
(mm) Line or Load MOV Protection 4 32
Isolating Contactor Pump Control Option 4
4 Option fits in standard unit space.
65 HMCP, MCCB 1, 2, 3 30.00 (762.0) 20.00 (508.0)
110 HMCP, MCCB 3, 4 36.00 (914.4) 20.00 (508.0) 5 Option adds 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) (1X) to 37 and 66 A units. 33
110 HMCP, MCCB 5 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0)
200 HMCP, MCCB 5,6 72.00 (1828.8) 3 20.00 (508.0) Table 29.4-6. FLA Ratings
290
290
HMCP, MCCB
HMCP, MCCB
6
7
72.00 (1828.8) 3
72.00 (1828.8) 3
32.00 (812.8)
48.00 (1219.2)
Ramp Current % Ramp Starts Similar to 34
of FLA Time Per Hour Starting Method
Bypass Starter Standard Duty
65
110
HMCP, MCCB
HMCP, MCCB
1, 2, 3
3, 4
30.00 (762.0)
36.00 (914.4)
20.00 (508.0)
20.00 (508.0)
300% 30 seconds 3 Soft start 35
500% 10 seconds 3 Full voltage
110 HMCP, MCCB 5 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0)
350% 20 seconds 3 Wye delta
200 HMCP, MCCB 5, 6 72.00 (1828.8) 3 24.00 (609.6)
2 Option fits in standard unit space.
480%
390%
20 seconds
20 seconds
2
3
80% RVAT
65% RVAT
36
3 Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract. 300% 20 seconds 4 50% RVAT
Severe Duty
450% 30 seconds 4 Soft start
37
500% 10 seconds 10 Full voltage
350% 65 seconds 3 Wye delta
480% 25 seconds 4 80% RVAT
38
390% 40 seconds 4 65% RVAT
300% 60 seconds 4 50% RVAT
39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.4-6 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom Arc Resistant January 2016
Sheet 29 064
Layout and Technical Data

SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drive Units CT (IH): High overload drives are capable of producing 200%
22 All Eatons standard units include a disconnect, an AC choke,
starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 150% overload
for one minute. Essentially a constant torque drive.
an output reactor and a door-mounted keypad. All plug-in
VT (IL): Low overload drives are capable of producing 200%
23 units have a built-in dynamic braking circuit through the FR5
frame size. Drive units that require door-mounted fans also starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 110% overload
include a CPT. for one minute.Essentially a variable torque drive.
24 Note: Output reactor not included on 240 V units.
Table 29.4-7. SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives Dimensions in Inches (mm)
25 AFD
Frame
Unit Nominal (VT)
hp IL
(CT)
IH
Branch
Protection
Minimum Typical Maximum

Amperes Amperes HMCP T.M. Height (X) Width Height (X) Width Height (X) Width
26 200240 V
FR4 Drawout 0.75 3.7 3.7 7 15 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
1.0 4.8 4.8 15 15 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
27 1.5
2.0
6.6
7.8
6.6
7.8
15
15
15
15
18.0 (457.2)
18.0 (457.2)
3X
3X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
30.0 (762.0)
30.0 (762.0)
5X
5X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
3.0 11.0 15 25 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
3.0 11.0 15 25 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
28 FR5 Drawout 5.0 17.5 17.5 30 40 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
7.5 25.0 25.0 50 50 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
10.0 31.0 50 70 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
29 FR6 Drawout 10.0 31.0 31.0 50 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
15.0 48.0 48.0 100 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
20.0 61.0 100 125 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
30 FR7 Fixed 20.0 61.0 100 125 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
25.0 75.0 75.0 100 175 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
30.0 88.0 88.0 100 220 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
31 35.0 114.0 150 285 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
380500 V
FR4 Drawout 1.0 2.2 2.2 7 15 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
32 1.5 3.3 3.3 7 15 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
2.0 4.3 4.3 7 15 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
3.0 5.6 5.6 15 15 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
33 5.0
5.0
7.6
7.6
15
15
25
25
18.0 (457.2)
24.0 (609.6)
3X
4X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
30.0 (762.0)
36.0 (914.4)
5X
6X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
36.0 (914.4)
42.0 (1066.8)
6X
7X
20.0 (508.0)
20.2 (508.0)
7.5 12.0 30 25 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
FR5 Drawout 7.5 12.0 30 25 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
34 10.0 16.0 16.0 30 35 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
15.0 23.0 23.0 30 50 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
20.0 31.0 50 60 24.0 (609.6) 4X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
35 FR6 Drawout 20.0 31.0 50 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
25.0 38.0 38.0 50 80 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
30.0 46.0 46.0 100 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
36 40.0 61.0 100 125 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
FR7 Fixed 40.0 61.0 100 125 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
50.0 72.0 72.0 100 150 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
37 60.0
75.0
87.0
105.0
87.0 100
150
175
225
54.0 (8229.6)
54.0 (8229.6)
9X
9X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)






72.0 (1828.8)
72.0 (1828.8)
12X
12X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
FR8 Fixed 75.0 105.0 150 225 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
100.0 140.0 140.0 150 300 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
38 125.0 170.0 170.0 250 400 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
150.0 205.0 400 500 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)

39 Note: In drawout, minimum does not contain an operator panel, typical contains a device panel and room for timers and relays,
maximum makes provisions for isolation contactors and bypass. In fixed, minimum contains a device panel and room for timers and
relays, maximum makes provisions for isolation contactors and bypass.
40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.4-7
January 2016 Freedom Arc Resistant
Sheet 29 065
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.4-8. Adjustable Frequency Drives Passive Filters Addition Table 29.4-9. Options
Hp SVX Drive Passive Input Height Unit Space (X) Plug-in Options 22
(Maximum) (Amperes) (Amperes) Option Boards 1

1
1.5
2.2
3.3
6
6
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
I/O Expander 2

2
23
Encoder Expander
3 5.6 6 36.0 (914.4) 6X Interbus S Communications 2
2
5
7.5
7.6
12
8
14
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
Modbus Communications
PROFIBUS DP Communications 2 24
10 16 21 36.0 (914.4) 6X LonWorks Communications 2

Can Open (Slave) Communications 2


15 23 27 36.0 (914.4) 6X
20 31 34 36.0 (914.4) 6X DeviceNet Communications 3 25
25 38 44 36.0 (914.4) 6X Johnson Controls N2 Communications 2

PROFIBUS DP (D9 Connector) 2


30 46 52 48.0 (1219.2) 8X
40 61 66 48.0 (1219.2) 8X EtherNet/IP Communications 2 26
50 72 83 48.0 (1219.2) Modbus TCP Communications 2
8X
Modbus (D9 Connector) 2
60 87 103 48.0 (1219.2) 8X
75 105 128 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Plug-in Control Relays 27
100 140 165 60.0 (1524.0) 10X One relay 4

125 170 208 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Two relays 4

150 205 208 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Three relays 5 28


Note: Passive filters are a separate unit located next to the connected AFD. Other Options
Passive filters can reduce THD of the connected AFD to 8% or less. Automatic bypass circuit 6

Bypass drive test switch 6 29


Seven relay 120V control with CPT 4

Isolated signal processor 2

315 PSIG interface 2


30
Dynamic breaking resistors g

Graphics keypad 3

Line fuses 24
31
RFI filter 3

Deduct to remove output filter h

V1K 2000 ft (610 m) Dv/Dt filter 5 32


Output contactor 2

Dual overloads 25
33
Three contactor bypass 25

1 Up to five option boards may be selected.


Please see Tab 31 for detailed information. 34
2 All options will fit in typical and maximum
option unit.
3
4
This option will fit in all units. 35
One of these options will fit in 530 hp CT at
480 V frame standard units, 130 hp CT at
480 V typical and maximum option units.
5 All options will fit in maximum option unit. 36
6 Use with bypass option.
g DB resistors are to be mounted by the
customer external to the MCC. 37
h Not available for 240 V units.
Note: Output reactor or Dv/Dt filter not
required for motor lead lengths shorter 38
than 100 feet (30.4 m)30 feet (9.1 m) for
2 hp and below).
Note: Maximum motor lead length is
160 feet (48.8 m) for 1.5 hp and below,
39
330 feet (100.6 m) for 2 hp and 400 feet
(121.9 m) for 3 hp and larger when using
a standard output reactor. 40
Note: Motor lead lengths up to 2000 feet
(609.6 m) can be achieved by using a
Dv/Dt filter. 41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.4-8 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom Arc Resistant January 2016
Sheet 29 066
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.4-10. Main Incoming Line and Feeder Circuit BreakersMolded-Case Circuit BreakersDimensions in Inches (mm)
22 Frames reflect standard circuit breakers. Unit spacings shown include sufficient space to terminate cables on any standard
breaker lug. If cable sizes exceed those listed, add 12.00-inch (304.8 mm) space for lug adapters.
23 Frame Size
(Amperes)
Circuit Breaker
Frame
Interrupting Capacity (kAIC) Main Incoming Size Feeder Unit Size Maximum
Cable Size 1
240 V 480 V 575 V Inches (mm) X Space Inches (mm) X Space

125 E125H 65 65 25 12.00 (3048.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 1X 2 or 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
24 150 HFD 65 65 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
225 HFD 65 65 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 4/0 (one per phase)
25 225 J250 65 65 25 24.00 (609.6) 4X 18.00 (457.2) 1X 2 or 3X 4/0 (one per phase)
250 J250 65 65 25 30.00 (762.0) 5X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 350 kcmil (one per phase)
65 65 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X
26 400 HKD 65 65 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X 30.00 (762.0) 4X 250 kcmil (two per phase)
or 500 kcmil
(one per phase)
27 600 HLD 65 65 35 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 30.00 (762.0) 5X 500 kcmil (two per phase)
800 NGH 3 65 65 50 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 42.00 (1066.8) 12X 750 kcmil (three per phase)
1200 NGH 3 65 65 35 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 42.00 (1066.8) 12X 750 kcmil (three per phase)
28 2000 RGH 3 65 65 50 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 4 12X 750 kcmil (six per phase)
2500 RGH 3 65 65 50 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 72.00 (1828.8)45 12X 750 kcmil (six per phase)
29 1
2
See circuit breaker terminal data for variations.
Compact feeder units.
3 Digitrip 310+ LS is standard and included in the pricing.
30 4
5
The main breaker requires the complete vertical section. The rear is unusable.
24.00-inch (609.6 mm) wide.

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.5-1
January 2016 Freedom FlashGard
Sheet 29 067
General Description

Freedom FlashGard Quick Reference Layout Guide Index


22
Device Space Requirements Table Page
Short-Circuit Ratings for Motor Control (480 V) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-1 29.5-2
Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors 23
or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-2 29.5-2
Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-3 29.5-5 24
Option Sizing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-4 29.5-5
Control Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-5 29.5-5
FLA Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-6 29.5-5
25
Combination Starters with Fusible Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-7 29.5-6
Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty RatingsFusible. . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-8 29.5-8 26
Control Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-9 29.5-8
Option Sizing for Isolating Contactor and Bypass Starter . . . . . . 29.5-10 29.5-8 27
FLA Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-11 29.5-8
Freedom SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives. . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-12 29.5-9 28
Freedom FlashGard Motor Control Center Adjustable Frequency Drives Passive Filters Addition. . . . . . . . . 29.5-13 29.5-10
SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives in NEMA 3R MCCs . . . . 29.5-14 29.5-10
29
General Description Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-15 29.5-10
CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives, Thermal-Magnetic
Eatons Freedom FlashGard MCCs are
an industry first in addressing the
Breaker and Motor Circuit Protector (MCP) Disconnect . . . . . . 29.5-16 29.5-11 30
dangers associated with an arc flash CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives,
event by minimizing the risk of arc Fusible Switch Disconnect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-17 29.5-11
flash exposure. Freedom FlashGard Main Incoming Line and Feeder Circuit Breakers
31
offers features to help prevent injury Molded-Case Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-18 29.5-12
from electric shock, arc-flash burn and Main Circuit BreakersMagnum DS Air Circuit Breakers 32
arc-blast impacts, and is the first arc Manually or Electrically OperatedFixed Mounted . . . . . . . . . 29.5-19 29.5-12
preventative MCC.
Main Circuit BreakersMagnum DS Air Circuit Breakers,
Manually or Electrically OperatedDrawout Mounted. . . . . . . 29.5-20 29.5-13 33
Digitrip Units . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-21 29.5-13
Main-Tie-Main Auto Throw-Over Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-22 29.5-13 34
Freedom FlashGard Main Incoming Line and
Feeder Fusible Switches. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29.5-23 29.5-13
35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.5-2 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom FlashGard January 2016
Sheet 29 068
Layout and Technical Data

The FlashGard motor control center uses a patented heading. The RotoTract is a movable stab that can be
22 technology for arc flash prevention called the RotoTract, installed on any MCC unit 20.00 inches wide and less than
which allows the user to retract the stabs from the bus from 400 A of ampacity and is a drawout unit. Fixed units do not
behind a deadfront. The RotoTract is described more in have the RotoTract nor do units wider than 20.00 inches.
23 section 29.1-8 under the Freedom FlashGard Stab Assembly

24 Technical Data
Table 29.5-1. Short-Circuit Ratings for Motor Control (480 V)
25 Short-Circuit
Protective Device
Combination Starter
FV and RV (kA)
Solid-State
Reduced Voltage (kA)
Adjustable
Frequency Drives (kA)

HMCP motor circuit protector (standard rating) 65 65 65


26 HMCP motor circuit protector (optional rating) 100 100 100
MCCB molded-case circuit breaker (standard rating) 65 65 65
MCCB molded-case circuit breaker (optional rating) 100 100
27 Fusible switch 100 100 100

Table 29.5-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers
28 Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors.
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP/HMCPE MCCB Freedom FlashGard
29 Size Frame 12 Frame 3 Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
Full Voltage Non-Reversing Type F206
30
125 E 12.00 (304.8) 4 2X 4
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 18.00 (457.2) 3X
31 2 10 15 25 25 25
125
150
E
HFD/FDC
12.00 (304.8) 4
18.00 (457.2)
2X 4
3X
125 E 18.00 (457.2) 5 3X 5
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X
32 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 6 4X 68
4 40 50 75 100 100 150 HJD/JDC 30.00 (762.0) 7 5X i

33 5
50
75
60
100
100
150
125
200
150
200
250
400
HJD/JDC
HKD/KDC
36.00 (914.4)
42.00 (1066.8)
6X
7X
25 100 250 300 400 600 HLD/LDC j 48.00 (1219.2) 8X
67 150 350
34 200 300 400 1200 HND 72.00 (1828.8) l 12X
77 300 600 600 1200 HND 72.00 (1828.8) l 12X
35 Full Voltage Reversing Type F216
125 E 24.00 (609.6) 5 4X 5
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X
36 125 E 24.00 (609.6) 5 4X 5
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X
3 25 30 50 50 50 125/150 HFD/FDC/E 24.00 (609.6) m 4X
37 4 40 50 75 100 100 150 HJD/JDC 36.00 (914.4) m 6X 8n
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 66.00 (1676.4) 11X
38 125 100 250 300 400 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) l 12X
67 150 200 300 400 1200 HND 72.00 (1828.8) o 12X o
1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE magnetic only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V.
39 Optional HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V.
2 E-Frame motor circuit protection available for size 13 starters only.
3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
40 4
5
12.00-inch (304.8 mm)/2X unit is standard.
18.00-inch (457.2 mm)/3X unit is standard.
6 Minimum 30.00-inch (762.0 mm) space needed with thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.
41 7
8
Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract.
1X additional space required with solid-state overloads.
i 1X additional space with advanced solid-state overload.
42 j
k
1200 A HMCP frame available in 11X 66.00-inch (1676.4 mm).
For top entry, 8X space required.
l Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
m 30.00-inch (762.0 mm) space needed for thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.
43 n 7X with solid-state overloads.
o Requires 36.00-inch (914.4 mm) wide structure.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.5-3
January 2016 Freedom FlashGard
Sheet 29 069
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.5-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers (Continued)
Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors. 22
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP MCCB Freedom FlashGard
Size Frame 12 Frame 23
Unit Size 23
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
Two-Speed One Winding, Constant/Variable Torque Type F946 24
125 E 4X
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24 (609.6) 4 4X
125 E 24 (609.6) 4 4X 25
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 30 (762.0) 5X
125 E
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HJD/JDC 36 (914.4) 45 6X 26
150 HFD/FDC
4 40 50 75 100 100 250 HJD/JDC 42 (1066.8) 45 7X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 27
56 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72 (1828.8) 7 12X
Two-Speed Two Winding, Constant/Variable Torque Type F956
125 E 28
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X
125 E
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 4X 29
3 125 E
25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 5X
30 40 60 75 100 150 HFD/FDC 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 9 30
4 40 50 75 100 250 HJD/JDC 42.00 (1066.8) 8 7X 9
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC
56 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 7 12X 31
Reduced Voltage Autotransformer 6 Type F606
2 10 15 25 25 25 150 HFD/FDC 36.00 (914.4) 7X
3 25 30 50 50 50 150 HFD/FDC 48.00 (1219.2) 9X
32
4 30 50 75 100 100 150 HJD/JDC 54.00 (1371.6) 10X
50 60 100 125 150 250 HJD/JDC 33
5 75 100 150 200 200 400 HKD/KDC 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
6 150 200 300 400 400 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
7 300 600 600 1200 HND 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X 34
Reduced Voltage Part Winding 6 Type F706
1PW 10 10 15 15 15 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 5X
35
2PW 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 24.00 (609.6) 5X
3PW 40 50 75 75 75 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 6X
100 125 150 HFD/FDC 36
60 60 125 150 150 250 HJD/JDC
4PW 75 75 150 400 HKD/KDC 36.00 (914.4) k 7X
100 125 250 300 400 HKD/KDC 37
5PW 150 150 250 350 350 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE Magnetic Only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V.

2
Optional HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V. 38
E-Frame motor circuit protector available through size 3 starter only.
3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
4
5
Add 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space for low speed disconnect.
42.00-inch (1066.8 mm) space needed with Thermal-magnetic circuit breaker. 48.00-inch (1219.2 mm) space needed with thermal-magnetic
39
circuit breaker.
6 Fixed assemblies not available with RotoTract.
7 Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
40
8 36.00-inch (914.4 mm) space needed for thermal-magnetic circuit breaker.
9 1X additional space required with standard SSOL and 2X additional space required with advanced SSOL.
j Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep, 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure. 41
k For starting speed disconnect, add 6.00-inch (152.4 mm) space.

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.5-4 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom FlashGard January 2016
Sheet 29 070
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.5-2. Combination Starters with Series C Motor Circuit Protectors or Molded-Case Circuit Breakers (Continued)
22 Motor circuit protector ratings are suitable for both NEMA Design B and NEMA Design E (high efficiency) motors.
Per NEC, the motor circuit protectors may be adjusted to 17X motor FLA.
NEMA Maximum Horsepower HMCP MCCB Freedom FlashGard
23 Size Frame 12 Frame 23
Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space

24 Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Open Transition 4 Type F806


2YD 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 30.00 (762.0) 6X
30 40 75 75 5 150 HFD/FDC
25 3YD 40 50 250 HJD/JDC 42.00 (1066.8) 8X
60 75 125 150 150 250 HJD/JDC
4YD 150 400 HKD/KDC 48.00 (1219.2) 9X
26 100 125 200 250 300 400 HKD/KDC
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 5 12X
Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Closed Transition 4 Type F896
27 2YD 20 25 40 40 40 150 HFD/FDC 42.00 (1066.8) 8X
3YD 40 50 250 HFD/FDC 54.00 (1371.6) 10X

28 4YD
60

75 125
150
150

150

250
400
HJD/JDC
HKD/KDC 60.00 (1524.0) 11X
100 125 200 250 300 400 HKD/KDC
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 HLD/LDC 72.00 (1828.8) 5 12X
29 1 Standard combination starter units with HMCP/HMCPE magnetic only disconnect have short-circuit ratings of 65,000 A at 480 V.
Optional HMCP/HMCPE combination starter units are available with 100,000 A at 480 V.
2 E-Frame motor circuit protector available through size 3 starter only.
30 3 Optional combination starter units with thermal-magnetic breaker disconnects are available with either 65,000 or 100,000 A at 480 V.
4 Fixed assemblies not available with RotoTract.
5 Requires 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep, 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.5-5
January 2016 Freedom FlashGard
Sheet 29 071
Layout and Technical Data

S811+ Solid-State Reduced Voltage Starter Motor Service Factor (SF) Effect on S811+ Starter Selection
Eatons S811+ solid-state reduced voltage starter uses SCRs A 1.0 service factor motor may draw up to 22
when starting and a low impedance run circuit during 1.00 x full load amperes
operation. The S811+ solid-state starter has five 24 Vdc A 1.15 service factor motor may draw up to
inputs and two relay outputs. S811+ soft start units include 1.15 x full load amperes (15% more current). 23
a disconnect, starter, 24 Vdc power supply and 100 VA CPT. This chart is based off of a 1.15 SF motor selection
S811+ starters are current rated devices. In some cases,
a larger S811+ SSRV starter must be supplied for 1.15 SF
24
motors. See the maximum horsepower chart below
Table 29.5-3. Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty Ratings 1 25
S811+ S811+ 208 V 230 V 380 V 460 V 575 V Inches X
Amperage Frame hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse (mm) Space
Fuse hp
26
Standard Duty
37 65 10 50 70 30/60 10 50 70 30/60 15 50 70 30/60 20 50 70 30/60 30 50 80 30/60 18 (457.2) 3X
66
105
65
110
15 100
30 150
125 100 20 100
225 200 30 150
125 100 30
200 200 45
100
150
150 100 40 100
150 200 60 150
150 100 50 100
150 200 75 150
150 100 18 (457.2)
200 200 24 (609.6)
3X
4X
27
135 110 40 150 225 200 40 150 250 200 55 150 250 200 75 1 50 250 200 100 150 250 200 24 (609.6) 4X
180
240
200
200
50 250
60 250
400
400
400
400
60 250
75 250
350
450
400 75
400 110
250
400
350
500
400 125 250
400 150 400
400
500
400 150 250
400 200 250
350
450
400 42 (1066.8) 7X
400 42 (1066.8) 7X
28
304 200 75 400 600 400 100 400 600 600 132 400 600 600 200 400 600 600 250 400 600 600 42 (1066.8) 7X
360
420
290
290
100 400
125 600
700
900
600 125 400
600
800 600 160
200
600
600
800 600
1000 800 300 600
300 400
1000 800 350 600
800
900
600 54 (1371.6) 9X
600 54 (1371.6) 9X
29
500 290 150 600 1000 800 250 600 1000 800 350 600 1000 800 450 600 1000 800 54 (1371.6) 9X
650 290 200 1200 1200 1200 200 1200 1200 800 315 1200 1200 1200 450 1200 1200 1200 600 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
720 290 250 1200 1200 1200 500 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X 30
850 290 300 1200 1200 1200 375 1200 1200 1200 600 1200 2000 1200 700 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
1000 290 350 2000 2000 1200 500 2000 2000 1200 700 2000 2000 1200 900 2000 2000 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
Severe Duty
31
22 65 5 70 40 5 70 35 7.5 60 35 10 60 35 15 70 40 18 (457.2) 3X
42 65 10 125 70 10
65 110 15 200 110 20
125
200
70
125
18.5
22
150
150
90
100
25
40
150
150
80
125
30
50
125
200
80 18 (457.2)
125 24 (609.6)
3X
4X
32
80 110 20 225 150 25 300 175 37 300 175 50 250 150 60 250 150 24 (609.6) 4X
115 200 30 300 225 30 350 200 55 300 250 75 300 225 100 300 250 42 (1066.8) 7X
150 200 40 350 250 50 400 300 100 400 300 125 400 300 42 (1066.8) 7X 33
192 200 50 400 350 60 500 350 90 500 400 125 500 400 150 400 350 42 (1066.8) 7X
240 290 60 500 400 --- 110 600 500 150 600 450 --- --- 54 (1371.6) 9X
305 290 75 700 500 100 800 600 132 800 600 200 800 600 250 800 600 54 (1371.6) 9X 34
365 290 100 900 700 125 1000 800 160 900 700 250 1000 700 300 900 700 72 (1828.8) 12X
420 290 125 1000 800 200 1200 800 300 1200 800 350 1000 800 72 (1828.8) 12X
480 290 --- 150 1200 800 220 1200 1000 350 1200 1000 450 1200 1000 72 (1828.8) 12X 35
525 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
600 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
1 Standard-duty ratings reflect the maximum starting duty that these units are designed to supply. 36
Table 29.5-4. Option SizingDimensions in Inches (mm) Table 29.5-5. Control Options
S811+ Disconnect Starter Option Unit Structure Extra 50 VA Control Power Transformer 45 37
Width Type Size Size 2 Width 24 Vdc Control 4
(mm) Line or Load MOV Protection 4
Pump Control Option 4
Isolating Contactor
4 Option fits in standard unit space.
38
65 HMCP, MCCB 1, 2, 3 30.00 (762.0) 20.00 (508.0)
110 HMCP, MCCB 3, 4 36.00 (914.4) 20.00 (508.0) 5 Option adds 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) (1X) to 37 and 66 A units.
110 HMCP, MCCB 5 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0)
200 HMCP, MCCB 5,6 72.00 (1828.8) 3 20.00 (508.0) Table 29.5-6. FLA Ratings
39
290 HMCP, MCCB 6 72.00 (1828.8) 3 32.00 (812.8)
Ramp Current % Ramp Starts Similar to
290 HMCP, MCCB 7 72.00 (1828.8) 3 48.00 (1219.2)
of FLA Time Per Hour Starting Method
Bypass Starter Standard Duty
40
65 HMCP, MCCB 1, 2, 3 30.00 (762.0) 20.00 (508.0)
300% 30 seconds 3 Soft start
110 HMCP, MCCB 3, 4 36.00 (914.4) 20.00 (508.0)
110 HMCP, MCCB 5 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0)
500%
350%
10 seconds
20 seconds
3
3
Full voltage
Wye delta
41
200 HMCP, MCCB 5, 6 72.00 (1828.8) 3 24.00 (609.6) 480% 20 seconds 2 80% RVAT
290 HMCP, MCCB 6 72.00 (1828.8) 3 32.00 (812.8)
390% 20 seconds 3 65% RVAT
290 HMCP, MCCB 7 72.00 (1828.8) 3 48.00 (1219.2)
300% 20 seconds 4 50% RVAT 42
2 Option fits in standard unit space. Severe Duty
3 Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract.
450% 30 seconds 4 Soft start
500% 10 seconds 10 Full voltage 43
350% 65 seconds 3 Wye delta
480% 25 seconds 4 80% RVAT
390% 40 seconds 4 65% RVAT
300% 60 seconds 4 50% RVAT

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.5-6 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom FlashGard January 2016
Sheet 29 072
Layout and Technical Data

All of Eatons combination starters are available with Class R


22 or J fuse clips for all voltages. If 100 kA SCR is required at
575 V and 600 V, fuses must be used where current limiting
options are not available in combination with breakers.
23 When selecting fuse switches, the fuses are not supplied
by default. Fuses may be selected as follows:

24 RK5: 1.25x FLC


RK1: 1.3x FLC
Class J: 1.5x FLC
25
Table 29.5-7. Combination Starters with Fusible SwitchesDimensions in Inches (mm)
NEMA Maximum Horsepower Switch Freedom FlashGard
26 Size Rating 1 Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space
27 Full Voltage Non-ReversingFusible Type F204
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 18.00 (457.2) 3X
2 10 15 25 25 25 60 18.00 (457.2) 3X
28 3 25 30 50 50 50 60/100 24.00 (609.6) 4X
4 40 50 75 100 100 100/200 36.00 (914.4) 6X 2
29 5 75 100 150 200 200 400 3 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
66.00 (1676.4) 5 11X
64 150 200 300 400 400 600 72.00 (1828.8) 6 12X
30 Full Voltage ReversingFusible Type F214
1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 24.00 (609.6) 4X
2 10 15 25 25 25 60 24.00 (609.6) 4X
31 3 25 30 50 50 50 100/200 30.00 (762.0) 5X
4 40 50 75 100 100 200 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
32 54 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 7 12X
64 150 200 300 400 400 600 72.00 (1828.8) 7 12X
Two-Speed One WindingFusible Type F944
33 1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 24.00 (609.6) 4X
2 10 15 25 25 25 60 30.00 (762.0) 5X
34 3 25 30 30 50 60
25 30 50 50 50 100 36.00 (914.4) 6X
4 60 100
35 40 50 75 100 100 200 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
54 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 7 12X
Two-Speed Two WindingFusible Type F954
36 1 7.5 7.5 10 10 10 30 24.00 (609.6) 4X
2 10 15 25 25 25 60 30.00 (762.0) 5X

37 3

25

30

50

50
30
50
60
100 36.00 (914.4) 6X
60 100
4 40 50 75 100 100 200 54.00 (1371.6) 8 10X
38 54 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 7 12X
Reduced Voltage AutotransformerFusible 4 Type F604
39 2 10 15 25 25 25 60 36.00 (914.4) 7X
3 25 30 50 50 50 100 60.00 (1524.0) 10X
4 40 50 75 100 100 200 72.00 (1828.8) i 12X
40 5 75 100 150 200 200 400 72.00 (1828.8) 7 12X
6 150 200 300 400 400 600 72.00 (1828.8) j 12X
41 1 Combination fused starter units rated 100 kAIC short-circuit current.
2 7X (42.00-inch [1066.8 mm]) unit size with solid-state overloads.
3 Certain items in unit option Groups B and C may require additional space. See Page 29.3-8.
42 4
5
Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract.
For bottom entry of motor cables.
6 For top entry of motor cables.
43 7
8
Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure.
Add 12.00-inch (304.8 mm) space for low speed fuses.
i Bottom 24.00-inch (609.6 mm) space in rear is unusable.
j Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide and 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep structure.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.5-7
January 2016 Freedom FlashGard
Sheet 29 073
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.5-7. Combination Starters with Fusible Switches (Continued)


NEMA Maximum Horsepower Switch Freedom FlashGard 22
Size Rating 1 Unit Size
208 V 240 V 380 V 480 V 600 V Inches (mm) X Space 23
Reduced Voltage Part WindingFusible Type F704
1PW 10 10 15 15 15 60 24.00 (609.6) 5X
15 25 30 40 60 24.00 (609.6) 5X 24
2PW 20 25 40 40 100 24.00 (609.6) 5X
50 60 100 48.00 (1219.2) 9X
3PW 40 50 75 75 75 200 48.00 (1219.2) 9X 25
50 100 100 150 200 54.00 (1371.6) 10X
4PW 2 75 75 150 150 400 54.00 (1371.6) 10X
100 100 200 250 300 400 26
5PW 2 150 150 250 350 350 600 72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3
Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Open TransitionFusible Type F804
15 15 30 40 40 60
27
2YD 20 25 40 100 36.00 (914.4) 6X
25 30 50 60 75 100
3YD 40 50 75 75 200 54.00 (1371.6) 9X
28
50 60 100 125 150 200
4YD 2 60 75 150 150 400 72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3
100 125 200 250 300 400
29
5YD 2 150 150 250 300 600 72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3



200

350

400
350
500
400
600
30
250 250 400 500 700 800 72.00 (1828.8) 4 12X 4
6YD 2 300 350 500 700 700 1200
Reduced Voltage Wye Delta Closed TransitionFusible 2 Type F894 31
15 15 30 40 40 60
2YD 20 25 40 100 48.00 (1219.2) 8X
25 30 50 60 75 100
32
3YD 40 50 75 75 200 66.00 (1676.4) 12X
72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3
4YD
50
60
60
75
100
150
125
150
50 200
400 72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3
33
100 125 200 250 300 400
5YD 150 150 250 300 600 72.00 (1828.8) 3 12X 3
350 400
34
200 350 400 500 600
6YD 250 250 400 500 700 800 72.00 (1828.8) 4 12X 4
300 350 500 700 700 1200 35
1 Combination fused starter units rated 100 kAIC short-circuit current.
2 Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract.
3 Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide structure. 36
4 Requires 28.00-inch (711.2 mm) wide and 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep section.

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.5-8 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom FlashGard January 2016
Sheet 29 074
Layout and Technical Data

S811+ Solid-State Reduced Voltage StarterFusible Switch Motor Service Factor (SF) Effect on S811+ Starter Selection
22 Eatons S811+ solid-state reduced voltage starter uses SCRs A 1.0 service factor motor may draw up to
when starting and a low impedance run circuit during 1.00 x full load amperes
operation. The S811+ solid-state starter has five 24 Vdc A 1.15 service factor motor may draw up to
23 inputs and two relay outputs. S811+ soft start units include a 1.15 x full load amperes (15% more current).
disconnect, a starter, 24 Vdc power supply and 100 VA CPT. This chart is based off of a 1.15 SF motor selection
24 S811+ starters are current rated devices. In some cases,
a larger S811+ SSRV starter must be supplied for 1.15 SF
motors. See the maximum horsepower chart below
25 Table 29.5-8. Standard-Duty and Severe-Duty RatingsFusible 1
S811+ S811+ 208 V 230 V 380 V 460 V 575 V Inches X
26 Amperage Frame hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse hp HMCP T.M. Fuse (mm) Space

Standard Duty
37 65 10 50 70 30/60 10 50 70 30/60 15 50 70 30/60 20 50 70 30/60 30 50 80 30/60 18 (457.2) 3X
27 66 65 15 100 125 100 20 100 125 100 30 100 150 100 40 100 150 100 50 100 150 100 18 (457.2) 3X
105 110 30 150 225 200 30 150 200 200 45 150 150 200 60 150 150 200 75 150 200 200 24 (609.6) 4X
135 110 40 150 225 200 40 150 250 200 55 150 250 200 75 1 50 250 200 100 150 250 200 24 (609.6) 4X
28 180 200 50 250 400 400 60 250 350 400 75 250 350 400 125 250 400 400 150 250 350 400 42 (1066.8) 7X
240 200 60 250 400 400 75 250 450 400 110 400 500 400 150 400 500 400 200 250 450 400 42 (1066.8) 7X
304 2 200 75 400 600 400 100 400 600 600 132 400 600 600 200 400 600 600 250 400 600 600 42 (1066.8) 7X
29 360 2 290 100 400 700 600 125 400 800 600 160 600 800 600 300 400 800 600 54 (1371.6) 9X
420 2 290 125 600 900 600 200 600 1000 800 300 600 1000 800 350 600 900 600 54 (1371.6) 9X
500 2 290 150 600 1000 800 250 600 1000 800 350 600 1000 800 450 600 1000 800 54 (1371.6) 9X
30 650 2
720 2
290
290
200 1200

1200 1200 200 1200
250 1200
1200 800 315
1200 1200
1200

1200 1200 450 1200
500 1200
1200 1200 600 1200
1200 1200
1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
72 (1828.8) 12X
850 2 290 300 1200 1200 1200 375 1200 1200 1200 600 1200 2000 1200 700 1200 1200 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
31 1000 2 290 350 2000 2000 1200 500 2000 2000 1200 700 2000 2000 1200 900 2000 2000 1200 72 (1828.8) 12X
Severe Duty
22 65 5 70 40 5 70 35 7.5 60 35 10 60 35 15 70 40 18 (457.2) 3X
32 42
65
65
110
10
15
125
200
70
110
10
20
125
200
70
125
18.5
22
150
150
90
100
25
40
150
150
80
125
30
50
125
200
80 18 (457.2)
125 24 (609.6)
3X
4X
80 110 20 225 150 25 300 175 37 300 175 50 250 150 60 250 150 24 (609.6) 4X
33 115
150
200
200
30
40
300
350
225
250
30
50
350
400
200 55
300


300 250 75
100
300
400
225 100
300 125
300
400
250 42 (1066.8) 7X
300 42 (1066.8) 7X
192 2 200 50 400 350 60 500 350 90 500 400 125 500 400 150 400 350 42 (1066.8) 7X
34 240 2
305 2
290
290
60
75
500
700
400 ---
500 100
110
800 600 132


600
800
500 150
600 200
600
800
450 ---
600 250
--- 54 (1371.6) 9X
800 600 54 (1371.6) 9X
365 2 290 100 900 700 125 1000 800 160 900 700 250 1000 700 300 900 700 72 (1828.8) 12X
420 2 290 125 1000 800 200 1200 800 300 1200 800 350 1000 800 72 (1828.8) 12X
35 480 2 290 --- 150 1200 800 220 1200 1000 350 1200 1000 450 1200 1000 72 (1828.8) 12X
525 2 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
600 2 290 72 (1828.8) 12X
36 1 Option adds 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) (1X) to 37 and 66 A units.
2 Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract.

37 Table 29.5-9. Control Options Table 29.5-11. FLA Ratings


Extra 50 VA Control Power Transformer 3 Ramp Current % Ramp Starts Similar to
24 Vdc Control 3 of FLA Time Per Hour Starting Method
38 Line or Load MOV Protection 3 Standard Duty
Pump Control Option 3
300% 30 Seconds 3 Soft start
3 Option fits in standard unit space. 500% 10 Seconds 3 Full voltage
39 350% 20 Seconds 3 Wye delta
Table 29.5-10. Option Sizing for Isolating Contactor and Bypass Starter 480% 20 Seconds 2 80% RVAT
S811+ Fused Starter Option FlashGard Structure 390% 20 Seconds 3 65% RVAT
40 Width Switch Size Unit Size Unit Size Width 300% 20 Seconds 4 50% RVAT
(mm) Type Inches Inches Inches Severe Duty
(Amperes) (mm) (mm) (mm)
450% 30 seconds 4 Soft start
41 65 30/60/100 1, 2, 3 36.00 (914.4) 36.00 (914.4) 20.00 (508.0) 500% 10 seconds 10 Full voltage
110 100 3 42.00 (1066.8) 42.00 (1066.8) 20.00 (508.0) 350% 65 seconds 3 Wye delta
110 200 4 54.00 (1371.6) 54.00 (1371.6) 20.00 (508.0) 480% 25 seconds 4 80% RVAT
42 200 4
290 4
400/800
600/800
5, 6
6
72.00 (1828.8)
72.00 (1828.8)
72.00 (1828.8)
72.00 (1828.8)
32.00 (812.8)
36.00 (914.4)
390% 40 seconds 4 65% RVAT
300% 60 seconds 4 50% RVAT
290 4 800/1200 7 72.00 (1828.8) 72.00 (1828.8) 64.00 (1625.6)

43 4 Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract.

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.5-9
January 2016 Freedom FlashGard
Sheet 29 075
Layout and Technical Data

SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drive Units CT (IH): High overload drives are capable of producing 200%
All Eatons standard units include a disconnect, an AC choke,
starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 150% overload 22
for one minute. Essentially a constant torque drive.
an output reactor and a door-mounted keypad. All plug-in
units have a built-in dynamic braking circuit through the FR5 VT (IL): Low overload drives are capable of producing 200%
frame size. Drive units that require door-mounted fans also starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 110% overload
23
include a CPT. for one minute.Essentially a variable torque drive.
Note: Output reactor not included on 240 V units. 24
Table 29.5-12. Freedom SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency DrivesDimensions in Inches (mm)
AFD Unit Nominal (VT) (CT) Branch Protection Minimum Typical Maximum 25
Frame hp IL IH HMCP T.M. K-SW Height (X) Width Height (X) Width Height (X) Width
Amperes Amperes
200240 V 26
FR4 Drawout 0.75 3.7 3.7 7 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
1.0 4.8 4.8 15 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
1.5 6.6 6.6 15 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 27
2.0 7.8 7.8 15 15 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
3.0 11.0 15 25 30 18.0 (457.2) 3X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0)
3.0 11.0 15 25 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
28
FR5 Drawout 5.0 17.5 17.5 30 40 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
7.5 25.0 25.0 50 50 60 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
10.0 31.0 50 70 60 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
FR6 Drawout 10.0 31.0 31.0 50 60 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
29
15.0 48.0 48.0 100 100 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
20.0 61.0 100 125 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
FR7 Fixed 20.0 61.0 100 125 100 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
30
25.0 75.0 75.0 100 175 200 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
30.0 88.0 88.0 100 220 200 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
35.0 114.0 150 285 200 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0) 31
380500 V
FR4 Drawout 1.0 2.2 2.2 7 15 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
1.5 3.3 3.3 7 15 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 32
2.0 4.3 4.3 7 15 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
3.0 5.6 5.6 15 15 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
5.0
5.0
7.6
7.6
15
15
25
25
30
30
30.0 (762.0)
30.0 (762.0)
5X
5X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
30.0 (762.0)
30.0 (762.0)
5X
5X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
42.0 (1066.8)
42.0 (1066.8)
7X
7X
20.2 (508.0)
20.2 (508.0)
33
7.5 12.0 30 25 30 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 30.0 (762.0) 5X 20.0 (508.0) 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0)
FR5 Drawout 7.5
10.0

16.0
12.0
16.0
30
30
25
35
30
30
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
48.0 (1219.2)
48.0 (1219.2)
8X
8X
20.2 (508.0)
20.2 (508.0)
34
15.0 23.0 23.0 30 50 60 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 48.0 (1219.2) 8X 20.2 (508.0)
20.0 31.0 50 60 60 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 36.0 (914.4) 6X 20.0 (508.0) 48.0 (1219.2) 8X 20.2 (508.0)
FR6 Drawout 20.0 31.0 50 60 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
35
25.0 38.0 38.0 50 80 60 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
30.0 46.0 46.0 100 100 80 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0)
40.0 61.0 100 125 100 42.0 (1066.8) 7X 20.2 (508.0) 54.0 (8229.6) 9X 20.0 (508.0) 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0) 36
FR7 Fixed 40.0 61.0 100 125 100 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
50.0 72.0 72.0 100 150 100 60.0 (2362.2) 10X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0)
60.0
75.0
87.0
105.0
87.0 100
150
175
225
100
175
60.0 (2362.2)
60.0 (2362.2)
10X
10X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)






72.0 (1828.8)
72.0 (1828.8)
12X
12X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)
37
FR8 Fixed 75.0 105.0 150 225 175 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 32.0 (812.8)
100.0
125.0
140.0
170.0
140.0
170.0
150
250
300
400
200
250
72.0 (1828.8)
72.0 (1828.8)
12X
12X
20.0 (508.0)
20.0 (508.0)






72.0 (1828.8)
72.0 (1828.8)
12X
12X
32.0 (812.8)
32.0 (812.8)
38
150.0 205.0 400 500 3 50 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 20.0 (508.0) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 32.0 (812.8)
205.0 400 500 350 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 28.0 (711.2) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 40.0 (1016.0)
FR9 Fixed 150.0
200.0 261.0 261.0 400 600 450 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 28.0 (711.2) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 40.0 (1016.0)
39
250.0 1 300.0 400 700 500 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 28.0 (711.2) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 40.0 (1016.0)
FR10 Fixed 250.0 300.0 400 700 500 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
300.0 385.0 385.0 600 800 600 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0) 40
350.0 460.0 460.0 600 1000 800 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
400.0 520.0 1200 1200 800 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 64.0 (1625.6) 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
FR11 Fixed 400.0 590.0 1200 1200 1000 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0) 41
500.0 650.0 650.0 1200 1500 1000 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
550.0 730.0 730.0 1200 1600 1200 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 80.0 (2032.0)
FR12 Fixed 600.0 820.0 1200 1600 1200 72.0 (1828.8) 12X 128.0 (3251.2) 42
1 If a 250 hp 40 C rating is required, then up-size to the FR10. This FR9 sizing is only valid at 30 C ambient.
Note: FR9 and larger AFD units require a 21.00-inch (533.4 mm) deep enclosure. FR11 and FR12 are non UL designs; consult factory for specific
application. These tables are sized using the Motor Load Block up to 180 A; units without Motor Load Block may be smaller. In drawout, 43
minimum does not contain an operator panel, typical contains a device panel and room for timers and relays, maximum makes provisions
for isolation contactors and bypass. In fixed, minimum contains a device panel and room for timers and relays, maximum makes provisions for
isolation contactors and bypass. Consult factory for NEMA 3R sizing.

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.5-10 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom FlashGard January 2016
Sheet 29 076
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.5-13. Adjustable Frequency Drives Passive Filters Addition Table 29.5-15. Options
22 Hp SVX Drive Passive Input Height (X) Plug-in Options
(Maximum) (Amperes) (Amperes) Option Boards 4
23 1
1.5
2.2
3.3
6
6
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
I/O Expander 5

5
Encoder Expander
3 5.6 6 36.0 (914.4) 6X Interbus S Communications 5
5
24 5
7.5
7.6
12
8
14
36.0 (914.4)
36.0 (914.4)
6X
6X
Modbus Communications
PROFIBUS DP Communications 5

10 16 21 36.0 (914.4) 6X LonWorks Communications 5

Can Open (Slave) Communications 5


15 23 27 36.0 (914.4) 6X
25 20 31 34 36.0 (914.4) 6X DeviceNet Communications 6

25 38 44 36.0 (914.4) 6X Johnson Controls N2 Communications 5

PROFIBUS DP (D9 Connector) 5


30 46 52 48.0 (1219.2) 8X
26 40 61 66 48.0 (1219.2) 8X EtherNet/IP Communications 5

50 72 83 48.0 (1219.2) Modbus TCP Communications 5


8X
Modbus (D9 Connector) 5
60 87 103 48.0 (1219.2) 8X
27 75 105 128 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Plug-in Control Relays
100 140 165 60.0 (1524.0) 10X One relay 7

125 170 208 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Two relays 7

28 150 205 208 60.0 (1524.0) 10X Three relays 8

200 261 320 72.0 (1828.8) 12X Other Options


Note: Passive filters are a separate unit located next to the connected AFD. Automatic bypass circuit 9
29 Passive filters can reduce THD of the connected AFD to 8% or less. Bypass drive test switch 9

Seven relay 120V control with CPT 7

Table 29.5-14. SVX9000 Adjustable Frequency Drives in NEMA 3R MCCs Isolated signal processor 5

30 Dimensions in Inches (mm) 1 315 PSIG interface 5

j
IH Nominal IL Nominal CB Type 3 Unit Space (Typ./Max) Dynamic breaking resistors
Graphics keypad 6
Amperes hp IH 2 Amperes hp IL HMCP MCCB Dim. (X)
31 380500 V
Line fuses 57

RFI filter 6
2.2 1.0 3.3 1.5 7 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X
Deduct to remove output filter k
3.3 1.5 4.3 2.0 7 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X
32 4.3 2.0 5.6 3.0 7 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X V1K 2000 ft (610m) Dv/Dt filter 8
5.6 3.0 7.6 5.0 15 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X 5
Output contactor
7.6 5.0 12.0 7.5 15 15 30.00 (762.0) 5X
33 12.0 7.5 16.0 10.0 30 25 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
Dual overloads 58

Three contactor bypass 58


16.0 10.0 23.0 15.0 30 35 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
23.0 15.0 31.0 20.0 30 50 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 4 Up to five option boards may be selected.
34 31.0
38.0
20.0
25.0
38.0
46.0
25.0
30.0
50
50
60
80
72.00 (1828.8)
72.00 (1828.8)
12X
12X
Please see Tab 31 for detailed information.
5 All options will fit in typical and maximum
46.0 30.0 61.0 40.0 100 100 72.00 (1828.8) 12X option unit.
35 1 This table is common for both Freedom and Freedom FlashGard MCC.
6
7
This option will fit in all units.
One of these options will fit in 530 hp CT at
2 A separate CPT bucket is provided for all AFDs (15 hp) listed in the table.
3 For fusible disconnect, use typical option unit. 480 V frame standard units, 130 hp CT at
480 V typical and maximum option units.
36 Note: Drive units fit into a standard 20.00-inch (508.0 mm) wide structure. 8 All options will fit in maximum option unit.
9 Use with bypass option.
j DB resistors are to be mounted by the
37 customer external to the MCC.
k Not available for 240 V units.
Note: Output reactor or Dv/Dt filter not
38 required for motor lead lengths shorter
than 100 feet (30.4 m)30 feet (9.1 m) for
2 hp and below).
39 Note: Maximum motor lead length is
160 feet (48.8 m) for 1.5 hp and below,
330 feet (100.6 m) for 2 hp and 400 feet
(121.9 m) for 3 hp and larger when using
40 a standard output reactor.
Note: Motor lead lengths up to 2000 feet
(609.6 m) can be achieved by using a
41 Dv/Dt filter.

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.5-11
January 2016 Freedom FlashGard
Sheet 29 077
Layout and Technical Data

CPX9000 Clean Power Drives IH (CT): High overload drives are capable of producing 200%
1500 hp at 480 V starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 150% overload 22
for one minute. Essentially a constant torque drive.
Eatons CPX9000 Clean Power Drives use advanced 18-pulse,
IL (VT): Low overload drives are capable of producing 200%
clean-power technology that significantly reduces line
starting torque for 10 seconds and are rated 110% overload
23
harmonics at the drive input terminals, resulting in one
for one minute. Essentially a variable torque drive.
of the purest sinusoidal waveforms.
Table 29.5-16. CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives, Thermal-Magnetic Breaker and Motor Circuit Protector (MCP) Disconnect
24
Dimensions in Inches (mm)
Low Overload Drive 1 High Overload Drive 1 CB Type 2 Standard Unit Space Dimensions Inches (mm) 3 25
IL Nominal hp IH Nominal hp HMCP MCCB Width Height Depth (X)
Amperes IL Amperes IH

34 25 4 27 20 4 50 80 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X


26
40 30 4 34 25 4 100 100 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
52 40 4 40 30 4 100 125 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
65 50 4 52 40 4 100 150 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
27
77 60 4 65 50 4 100 175 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
96 75 4 77 60 4 150 225 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
124 100 4 96 75 4 150 300 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
28
156 125 4 124 100 4 250 400 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
180 150 4 156 125 4 400 400 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
240 200 180 150 600 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X 29
302 250 240 200 600 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
361 300 5 302 250 5 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
414 350 5 361 300 5 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 30
477 400 5 414 350 5 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
515 450 5 477 400 5 1200 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
590 500 5 515 450 5 1200 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 31
1 The CPX9000 drive uses the term Low Overload (IL) in place of the term Variable Torque and High Overload (IH) in place of the term
Constant Torque.
2 CPX9000 Drives in MCCs are available in thermal-magnetic breaker, motor circuit protector and fused disconnect configurations. 32
3 A minimum clearance of 4.00 inches (101.6 mm) should be provided at the back of CPX9000 Drive MCC section for ventilation.
4 Add 32.00 inches (812.8 mm) of width for bypass.
5 Required transformer section is 28.00 (711.2) inches deep; CPX and bypass is 21.00 (533.4) inches deep. 33
Table 29.5-17. CPX9000 Low Overload Clean Power Drives, Fusible Switch DisconnectDimensions in Inches (mm)
Low Overload Drive 6 High Overload Drive 6 Fuse Switch Standard Unit Space Dimensions Inches (mm) 7 34
IL Nominal hp IH Nominal hp Fuse Switch Width Height Depth (X)
Amperes IL Amperes IH
35
34 25 h 27 20 h 50 60 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
40 30 h 34 25 h 60 60 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
52 40 h 40 30 h 80 100 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
65 50 h 52 40 h 100 100 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
36
77 60 h 65 50 h 100 100 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
96 75 h 77 60 h 100 100 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
124 100 h 96 75 h 175 200 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
37
156 125 h 124 100 h 200 200 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
180 150 h 156 125 h 250 400 40.00 (1016.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
240 200 180 150 350 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X 38
302 250 240 200 450 600 60.00 (1524.0) 90.00 (2286.0) 21.00 (533.4) 12X
361 300 i 302 250 i 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
414 350 i 361 300 i 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 39
477 400 i 414 350 i 600 600 68.00 (1727.2) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
515 450 i 477 400 i 800 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X
590 500 i 515 450 i 800 1200 106.00 (2692.4) 90.00 (2286.0) 28.00 (711.2) 12X 40
6 The CPX9000 product uses the term Low Overload (IL) in place of the term Variable Torque and High Overload (IH) in place of the term
Constant Torque.
7 A minimum clearance of 4.00 inches (101.6 mm) should be provided at the back of CPX9000 Drive MCC section for ventilation. 41
h Add 32.00 inches (812.8 mm) of width for bypass.
i Required transformer section is 28.00 (711.2) inches deep; CPX and bypass is 21.00 (533.4) inches deep.
42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.5-12 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
Freedom FlashGard January 2016
Sheet 29 078
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.5-18. Main Incoming Line and Feeder Circuit BreakersMolded-Case Circuit BreakersDimensions in Inches (mm)
22 Frames reflect standard circuit breakers. Unit spacings shown include sufficient space to terminate cables on any standard
breaker lug. If cable sizes exceed those listed, add 12.00-inch (304.8 mm) space for lug adapters.
23 Frame Size
(Amperes)
Circuit Breaker
Frame
Interrupting Capacity (kAIC) Main Unit Size Feeder Unit Size Maximum
Cable Size 1
240 V 480 V 575 V Inches (mm) X Space Inches (mm) X Space

125 E125H 2 100 65 25 12.00 (304.8) 2X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
24 150 HFD 100 65 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
150 FDC 100 100 35 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 2X 4/0 (one per phase)
225 HFD 100 65 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 4/0 (one per phase)
25 225 J250 100 100 25 18.00 (457.2) 3X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 4/0 (one per phase)
FDC 100 100 35
250 J250 100 65 25 24.00 (609.6) 4X 18.00 (457.2) 3X 350 kcmil (one per phase)
26 JDC 100 100 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X
400 HKD 100 65 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X 30.00 (762.0) 4X 250 kcmil (two per phase)
KDC 100 100 50 or 500 kcmil
27 CHKD 3 100 65 35 30.00 (762.0) 5X 30.00 (762.0) 5X (one per phase)
CKDC 3 100 100 50
600 HLD 100 65 35 24.00 (609.6) 4X 30.00 (762.0) 5X 500 kcmil (two per phase)
28 LDC 100 100 50
CHLD 34 100 65 35 4X 24.00 (609.6) 4X
CLDC 34 100 100 50
29 800 NGC 100 100 50 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 750 kcmil (three per phase)
NGH-C 3 100 65 35 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X
NGC-C 3 100 100 50
30 1200 NGH 5 100 65 35 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 750 kcmil (three per phase)
NGC 5 100 100 50

31 NGH-C 34
NGC-C 34
100
100
65
100
35
50
72.00 (1828.8) 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X

2000 RGH 5 100 65 50 72.00 (1828.8) 6 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 750 kcmil (six per phase)
RGC 4 100 100 65
32 RGH-C 3 100 65 50
RGC-C 3 100 100 65
2500 RGH 100 65 50 72.00 (1828.8) 67 12X 72.00 (1828.8) 12X 750 kcmil (six per phase)
33 RGC 100 65 50
1 See circuit breaker terminal data for variations.
2 Compact feeder units.
34 3 Digitrip 310+ LS is required and included in the price.
4 NEMA 1 gasketed only.
5 Digitrip 310+ LS is standard and included in the pricing.
35 6 The main breaker requires the complete vertical section. The rear is unusable.
7 24.00 inches (609.6 mm) wide.
Note: RotoTract standard on all feeder taps 400 A and lower and not available on any main devices.
36
Table 29.5-19. Main Circuit BreakersMagnum DS Air Circuit Breakers, Manually or Electrically Operated
Fixed MountedDimensions in Inches (mm)
37 Frame Size Circuit Breaker Interrupting Capacity (kAIC) Unit Enclosure Enclosure
Amperes Type 240 V 480 V 575 V Size Width Depth

38 800 MDS-608 65 65 65 72.00 (1828.8) 24.00 (609.6) 21.00 (533.4)


MDS-C08 100 100 100
1600 MDS-616 65 65 65
39 MDS-C16 100 100 100
2000 MDS-620 65 65 65
MDS-C20 100 100 100
40 Note: A 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) filler section must be added between the main and the rest of the MCC to allow for door opening.

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E


Motor Control CentersLow Voltage 29.5-13
January 2016 Freedom FlashGard
Sheet 29 079
Layout and Technical Data

Table 29.5-20. Main Circuit Breakers Magnum DS Air Circuit Breakers, Manually or Electrically Operated
Drawout MountedDimensions in Inches (mm) 1 22
Frame Size Circuit Breaker Interrupting Capacity (kAIC) Unit Enclosure Enclosure
(Amperes) Type 240 V 480 V 575 V Size Width Depth
23
800 MDS-608 65 65 65 72.00 (1828.8) 24.00 (609.6) 2 42.00 (1066.8) 3
MDS-C08 100 100 100
1600 MDS-616 65 65 65 24
MDS-C16 100 100 100
2000 MDS-620 65 65 65
MDS-C20 100 100 100 25
3200 MDS-632 65 65 65
MDS-C32 100 100 100
1 This table is common for both Freedom and Freedom FlashGard MCCs. 26
2 A 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) filler section must be added between the main and the rest of the MCC to allow for door opening.
3 Structure is rear aligned.
27
Table 29.5-21. Digitrip Units Table 29.5-23. Freedom FlashGard Main Incoming Line and Feeder
Type Unit Space Fusible SwitchesDimensions in Inches (mm)
Inches (mm) Three-pole250 or 600 Vac. Fuses not included. 28
RMS 3101150 Refer to Page 21.4-10 Switch Fuse Unit Space
Rating f Clip Size Incoming Line
for more details.
Amps g Amps
Feeder
29
Options Inches (mm) X Space Inches (mm) X Space
Tie breaker 4 72.00 (1828.8) or 12X
30 30 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 3X
Electrically operated
60 60 18.00 (457.2) 3X 12.00 (304.8) 3X 30
Accessories 100 100 18.00 (457.2) 3X 24.00 (609.6) 3X
UV release-instantaneous 200 200 30.00 (762.0) 5X 36.00 (914.4) 5X
Shunt trip (standard on electrically operated 400 400 48.00 (1219.2) 8X 42.00 (1066.8) 7X 31
breakers) 600 600 54.00 (1371.8) ij 9X ij 48.00 (1219.2) j 8X j
Key interlock on breaker 800 800 48.00 (1219.2) jk 8X jk 48.00 (1219.2) jl 8X jl
Auxiliary switch (3A/3B) 1200 h 1200 60.00 (1524.0) j 10X j 60.00 (1524.0) j 10X j 32
Cell position switch f Suitable for 100,000 A interrupting if Class RK fuses are used.
Operations counter g Type of SW K-SW 30800 A.
Auxiliary power module (to test Digitrip)
Portable lift truck


h High magnetic molded-case switch. 33
i For bottom cable entry, add 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) or 1X space.
Manual close pushbutton cover j Fixed assemblies, no RotoTract.
4 Tie breaker adds an additional 20.00-inch (508.0 mm) wide bus
transition section. Also two 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) filler sections will
k For bottom entry, add 12.00 inches (304.8 mm) or 2X space. 34
l For top entry, add 6.00 inches (152.4 mm) or 1X space.
be added to the MCC if the tie breaker is located in the center of
the MCC lineup. If the tie breaker is located between the two main
structures, the two 4.00-inch (101.6 mm) fillers are not needed. 35
Table 29.5-22. Main-Tie-Main Auto Throw-Over Options
Option Description 36
AT200 Standard PLC-based control scheme. No operator interface
(PanelMate) provided. Sequence of operations and external
controls are pre-defined and not subject to customer
37
modifications. Type of voltage sensing device must be
chosen. If closed-transition operation is required, a
sync-check relay (device 25) must be used. 38
AT300 Same as AT200, except includes operator interface
(PanelMate). 5
AT300X Same as AT200, except customer modifications are acceptable. 39
This is the proper choice for PLC-based systems with special
sequences, more than main-tie-main configurations, and/or
where special PanelMate page layouts are required. 40
AT300IQ Standard Automatic Transfer Control (ATC) controller-based
control scheme for main-main configurations. Either or both
sources may be generators. Includes manual-auto operation,
and generator control switch. If closed-transition operation is
41
required, a sync-check relay (device 25) must be used.
5 Operator interface page layouts are pre-defined and not subject to
customer modifications.
42

43

CA08104001E For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants


29.5-14 Motor Control CentersLow Voltage
January 2016
Sheet 29 080

This page intentionally left blank.


22

23

24

25

26

27

28

29

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

39

40

41

42

43

For more information, visit: www.eaton.com/consultants CA08104001E

You might also like